blob: f7e4327325667cc6b71b2bf9e8c611eb6f4f487e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreaud1756702023-08-19 11:25:53 +02006 2023/08/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
729before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200730
731 Example:
732
733 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
734
735 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
736
737 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
738
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
740file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
743 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
744
745* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
746 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
747 directory.
748
749* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
750
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500751* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752 processes, separated by semicolons.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 CLI, separated by semicolons.
756
William Lallemanda48f51b2023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100757* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
758 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
759 updating the binary and reloading.
760
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200761In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
762regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
763only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
764
765* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
766
767* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
768 starting at one.
769
770* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
771 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
772 first section.
773
774These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
775if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
776section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
777"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
778proxies.
779
780This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
781logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
782to name some config objects like servers for example.
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200785
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100786
7872.4. Conditional blocks
788-----------------------
789
790It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
791some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
792ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
793configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
794versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
795preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
796text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
797lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
798switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
799are defined to form conditional blocks:
800
801 - .if <condition>
802 - .elif <condition>
803 - .else
804 - .endif
805
806The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
807as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
808matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
809there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
810only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
811".elif" of a block.
812
813Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
814ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
815as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
816
817The conditions are currently limited to:
818
819 - an empty string, always returns "false"
820 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
821 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200822 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
823
824The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
825
826 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
827 exists, regardless of its contents
828
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200829 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
830 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
831 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
832
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200833 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
834 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
835
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200836 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
841 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
842 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
843 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
844 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
845
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200846Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
849 listen mwcli_px
850 bind :1111
851 ...
852 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100853
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200854 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
855 bind :80
856 .endif
857
858 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200859 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200860 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 .endif
863
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200864 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
865 profiling.memory on
866 .endif
867
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200868Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100869
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200870 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100871 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
872 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
873 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
874
875Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
876"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
877fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
878provide advice to the user.
879
880Example:
881
882 .if "${A}"
883 .if "${B}"
884 .notice "A=1, B=1"
885 .elif "${C}"
886 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
887 .elif "${D}"
888 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
889 .else
890 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
891 .endif
892 .else
893 .notice "A=0"
894 .endif
895
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200896 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
897 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
898
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100899
9002.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200901----------------
902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100903Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100904values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
905otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
906numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
907for every keyword. Supported units are :
908
909 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
910 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
911 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
912 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
913 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
914 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
915
916
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009172.6. Size format
918----------------
919
920Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
921These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
922otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
923numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
924for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
925
926 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
927 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
928 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
929
930Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
931
932
9332.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200934-------------
935
936 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
937 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
938 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
939 global
940 daemon
941 maxconn 256
942
943 defaults
944 mode http
945 timeout connect 5000ms
946 timeout client 50000ms
947 timeout server 50000ms
948
949 frontend http-in
950 bind *:80
951 default_backend servers
952
953 backend servers
954 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
955
956
957 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
958 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
959 global
960 daemon
961 maxconn 256
962
963 defaults
964 mode http
965 timeout connect 5000ms
966 timeout client 50000ms
967 timeout server 50000ms
968
969 listen http-in
970 bind *:80
971 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
972
973
974Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
975
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100976 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200977
978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009793. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980--------------------
981
982Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
983are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
984of them have command-line equivalents.
985
986The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
987
988 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100989 - 51degrees-cache-size
990 - 51degrees-data-file
991 - 51degrees-property-name-list
992 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200995 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100996 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200997 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200998 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200999 - description
1000 - deviceatlas-json-file
1001 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001002 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001003 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001004 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001005 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - gid
1007 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001008 - h1-case-adjust
1009 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001010 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1011 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001012 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001013 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001014 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001015 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001017 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001018 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001020 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001021 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001022 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001023 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001024 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001025 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001026 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001028 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001029 - presetenv
1030 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001031 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001032 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001033 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001034 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001035 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001036 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001037 - ssl-default-bind-options
1038 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001039 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001040 - ssl-default-server-options
1041 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001042 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001043 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001044 - stats
1045 - strict-limits
1046 - uid
1047 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001048 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001049 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001050 - user
1051 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001052 - wurfl-data-file
1053 - wurfl-information-list
1054 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001055
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001057 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001058 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001059 - maxcompcpuusage
1060 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001062 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001063 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001064 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001065 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001066 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001067 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001068 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001070 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001071 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001072 - nokqueue
1073 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001074 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001075 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001076 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001077 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001078 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001079 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001080 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001081 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001082 - tune.buffers.limit
1083 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001084 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001085 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001086 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet48110bc2023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001087 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001088 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001089 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001090 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001091 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhus1da7ab32023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001092 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001093 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001094 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001095 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001096 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001097 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001098 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001099 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001100 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1102 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001103 - tune.maxaccept
1104 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001105 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001106 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001107 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001108 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1109 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001110 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1111 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001112 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001113 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001114 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001115 - tune.sndbuf.client
1116 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001117 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001118 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1119 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1120 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001121 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001122 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1123 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001124 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001125 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001126 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001127 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1128 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1129 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001130 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1131 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001134 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001135 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
1137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011383.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001139------------------------------------
1140
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100114151degrees-data-file <file path>
1142 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1143 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1146 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1147
114851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1149 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1150 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1151 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1152
1153 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1154 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1155
115651degrees-property-separator <char>
1157 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1158 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1159
1160 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1161 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1162
116351degrees-cache-size <number>
1164 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1165 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1166 By default, this cache is disabled.
1167
1168 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1169 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1170
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001171ca-base <dir>
1172 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001173 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1174 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1175 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177chroot <jail dir>
1178 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1179 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1180 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1181 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1182 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001183 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001184
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001185cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1186 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1187 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1188 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1189 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1190 set. These sets have the format
1191
1192 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1193
1194 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001195 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001196 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1197 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001198 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1199 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001200 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1201 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1202 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1203 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1204 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1205 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1206 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1207 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1208 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1209 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001210
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001211 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1212 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1213 on the machine's word size.
1214
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001215 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001216 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1217 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1218 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1219 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1220 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1221 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001222
1223 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001224 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1225
1226 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1227 # first 4 CPUs
1228
1229 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1230 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1231 # word size.
1232
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001233 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001234 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001235 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1236 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1237 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1238
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001239 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1240 # and so on.
1241 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1242 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1243 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1244
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001245 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001246 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1247 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1248 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1249
1250 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1251 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1252 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1253
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001254 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1255 # and a thread range.
1256 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1257 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1258 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1259
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001260crt-base <dir>
1261 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001262 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1263 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001264
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001265daemon
1266 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1267 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001268 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1269 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001270
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001271default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001272 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001273 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1274 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1275 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1276 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1277 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1278 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1279 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1280 not start with a slash ('/'):
1281 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1282 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1283
1284 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1285 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1286 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1287 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1288 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1289 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1290 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1291 each of them.
1292
1293 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1294 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1295 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1296 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1297 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1298 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1299 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1300 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1301
1302 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1303 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001304 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001305 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1306 made easily relocatable.
1307
1308 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1309 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1310 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1311 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1312 consistent across all configuration files.
1313
1314 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1315 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1316 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1317 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1318 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1319 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1320 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1321 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1322
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001323description <text>
1324 Add a text that describes the instance.
1325
1326 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1327 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1328 "<" and ">" characters.
1329
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001330deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1331 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001332 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001333
1334deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001335 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001336 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1337
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001338deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001339 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1340 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1341 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001342
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001343deviceatlas-separator <char>
1344 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1345 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1346
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001347expose-experimental-directives
1348 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1349 the config file will be rejected.
1350
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001351external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001352 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1353 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001354 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1355 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1356 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1357 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1358 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001359
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001360gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001361 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001362 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1363 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001364 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001365 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001366 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001367
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001368group <group name>
1369 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1370 See also "gid" and "user".
1371
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001372h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1373 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1374 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1375 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1376 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001377 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001378 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1379 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1380 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1381 specified in a proxy.
1382
1383 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1384 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1385 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1386 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1387 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1388 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1389 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1390
1391 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1392 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1393 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1394 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1395 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1396
1397 Example:
1398 global
1399 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1400
1401 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1402 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1403
1404h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1405 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1406 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1407 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1408 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1409 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1410 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1411 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1412 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1413
1414 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1415 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1416 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1417
1418 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1419 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1420
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001421h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1422 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1423 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1424 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1425 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1426 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1427 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1428 the keyword with "no'.
1429
1430hard-stop-after <time>
1431 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1432
1433 Arguments :
1434 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1435 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1436 SIGUSR1 signal.
1437
1438 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1439 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1440 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1441
1442 Example:
1443 global
1444 hard-stop-after 30s
1445
1446 See also: grace
1447
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001448insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001449 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001450 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1451 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1452 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1453 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1454 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1455 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1456 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001457 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001458 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1459 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1460 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1461 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1462 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1463 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1464 disable it.
1465
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001466insecure-setuid-wanted
1467 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1468 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1469 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1470 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001471 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001472 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001473 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001474 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1475 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001476 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001477 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1478 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1479 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1480 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1481
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001482issuers-chain-path <dir>
1483 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1484 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1485 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001486 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001487 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1488 "issuers-chain-path".
1489 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1490 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1491 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1492 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1493 will share the chain in memory.
1494
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001495localpeer <name>
1496 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1497 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1498 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1499 the configuration parsing.
1500
1501 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1502 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1503
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001504log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001505 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001506 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001507 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001508 configured with "log global".
1509
1510 <address> can be one of:
1511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001512 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001513 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1514 port).
1515
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001516 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1517 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1518 port).
1519
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001520 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001521 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1522 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001523 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001524
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001525 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1526 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1527 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1528 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1529 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1530 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1531 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1532 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1533 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1534 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001535 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001536 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1537 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1538 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001539 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1540 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001541
1542 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1543 "fd@2", see above.
1544
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001545 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1546 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1547 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1548 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1549 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1550
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001551 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1552 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001553
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001554 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1555 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1556 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1557 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1558 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1559 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1560 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1561 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1562 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1563 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001564 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1565 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001566
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001567 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1568 one of the following :
1569
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001570 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1571 field is stripped. This is the default.
1572 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1573 rfc3164.
1574
1575 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001576 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1577
1578 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1579 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1580
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001581 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1582 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1583 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1584 designed to be used with a local log server.
1585
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001586 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1587 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1588 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1589 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1590 logger consumes.
1591
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001592 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1593 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1594 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1595 used with a local log server.
1596
1597 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1598 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1599 designed to be used with a local log server.
1600
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001601 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1602 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1603 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1604 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1605
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001606 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1607 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1608 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1609 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1610 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1611
1612 <sample_size>
1613 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1614 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1615 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1616 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1617 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1618
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001619 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001621 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1622 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1623 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1624
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001625 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1626 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1627 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1628 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001629
1630 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001631 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1632 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1633 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1634 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1635 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1636 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001637
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001638 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001639
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001640log-send-hostname [<string>]
1641 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1642 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1643 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1644 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1645 the logs.
1646
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001647log-tag <string>
1648 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1649 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1650 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001651 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001652
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001653lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001654 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1655 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1656 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1657 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1658 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1659 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001660 used multiple times.
1661
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001662lua-load-per-thread <file>
1663 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1664 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1665 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1666 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1667 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1668 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1669 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1670 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1671 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1672 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1673 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1674 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1675 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1676 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1677 times.
1678
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001679lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1680 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1681 variable.
1682 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1683 to "path".
1684
1685 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1686 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1687 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1688 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1689 will be checked earlier.
1690
1691 As an example by specifying the following path:
1692
1693 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1694 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1695
1696 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1697 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1698 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1699 paths if that does not exist either.
1700
1701 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1702 documentation.
1703
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001704master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001705 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1706 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1707 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001708 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001709 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1710 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001711 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1712 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1713 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1714 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1715 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001716
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001717 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001718
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001719mworker-max-reloads <number>
1720 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001721 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001722 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1723 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1724 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1725
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001726nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1728 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1729 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001730 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1731 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001732 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1733 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1734 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001735
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001736nbthread <number>
1737 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001738 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001739 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1740 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1741 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1742 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001743 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1744 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1745 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1746 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1747 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1748 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1749 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001750
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001751numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001752 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001753 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1754 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1755 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1756 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1757 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1758 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1759 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1760 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1761
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001762pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001763 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1764 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1765 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1766 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001767
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001768pp2-never-send-local
1769 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1770 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1771 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1772 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1773 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1774 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1775 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1776 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1777 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1778 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1779 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1780
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001781presetenv <name> <value>
1782 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1783 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1784 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1785 and "unsetenv".
1786
1787resetenv [<name> ...]
1788 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1789 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1790 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1791 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1792 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1793 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1794 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1795 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1796
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001797stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001798 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1799 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1800 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1801 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1802 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1803 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001804 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001805 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1806 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1807 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1808 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001809
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001810server-state-base <directory>
1811 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001812 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1813 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001814
1815server-state-file <file>
1816 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1817 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1818 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1819 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1820 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1821 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1822 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1823 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001824 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1825 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001826
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001827set-dumpable
1828 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1829 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1830 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1831 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1832 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1833 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1834 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1835 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1836 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1837 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1838 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1839 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1840 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1841 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1842 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1843 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1844 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1845 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1846
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001847set-var <var-name> <expr>
1848 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1849 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1850 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1851 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1852 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1853 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1854 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1855 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1856 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1857
1858 Example:
1859 global
1860 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1861 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1862 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1863
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001864setenv <name> <value>
1865 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1866 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1867 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1868 and "unsetenv".
1869
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001870ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1872 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001873 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001874 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001875 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1876 information and recommendations see e.g.
1877 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1878 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1879 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1880 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001881
1882ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1884 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1885 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1886 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1887 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001888 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1889 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1890 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001891 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001892
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001893ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1895 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1896 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1897 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1898 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1899
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001900ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1902 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1903 keyword to see available options.
1904
1905 Example:
1906 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001907 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001908
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001909ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1911 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001912 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001913 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001914 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1915 information and recommendations see e.g.
1916 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1917 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1918 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1919 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1920 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001921
1922ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1924 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1925 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1926 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1927 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001928 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1929 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1930 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1931 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001932
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001933ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1935 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1936 keyword to see available options.
1937
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001938ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1940 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1941 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001942 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001943 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001944 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1945 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1946 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1947 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001948 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1949 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1950 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1951
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001952ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1953 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1954 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001955 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001956 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001957 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1958
1959 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001960
1961 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1962 and won't try to remove them.
1963
1964 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1965
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001966ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001967 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001968 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1969 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1970 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001971
1972 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1973 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1974 optimize the startup time.
1975
1976 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1977 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1978 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1979
1980 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001981 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001982
1983 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001984 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1985 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001986
1987 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1988 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1989 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1990 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1991 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001992 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001993
1994 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001995 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001996 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1997 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1998 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1999 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2000 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002001 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002002
2003 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2004
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002005 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002006 a cert bundle.
2007
2008 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2009 separately in several "crt".
2010
2011 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2012 since files are loading separately.
2013
2014 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2015 required to commit them.
2016
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002017 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002018 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002019
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002020 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2021 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2022 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002023
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002024 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2025 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2026 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002027
2028 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002029 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2030 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002031
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002032 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2033 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2034
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002035 The default behavior is "all".
2036
2037 Example:
2038 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2039 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2040 ssl-load-extra-files none
2041
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002042 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2043 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002044
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002045ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2046 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2047 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2048 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2049
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002050ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002051 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002052 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2053 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2054 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2055 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2056 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2057 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002058 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002059
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002060stats maxconn <connections>
2061 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2062 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2063
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002064stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2065 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2066 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2067 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002068 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002069 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002070
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002071 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2072 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2073 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002074
2075stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2076 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2077 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002078 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002079
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002080strict-limits
2081 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2082 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2083 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2084 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2085 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002086
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002087uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002088 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002089 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2090 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2091 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2092
2093ulimit-n <number>
2094 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2095 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2096 option.
2097
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002098unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2099 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2100
2101 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2102 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2103 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2104 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2105 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002106 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002107 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2108 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2109 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2110 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2111
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002112unsetenv [<name> ...]
2113 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2114 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2115 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2116 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2117 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2118 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2119 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002121user <user name>
2122 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2123 See also "uid" and "group".
2124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002125node <name>
2126 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2127
2128 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2129 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2130 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2131 traffic.
2132
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002133wurfl-cache-size <size>
2134 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2135 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2136 - "0" : no cache is used.
2137 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002138
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002139 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2140 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002141
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002142wurfl-data-file <file path>
2143 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2144 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002146 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002147 with USE_WURFL=1.
2148
2149wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2150 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2151 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2152 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2153
2154 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2155
2156 Valid WURFL properties are:
2157 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2158
2159 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2160 device.
2161
2162 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2163 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2164
2165 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2166 particular web request.
2167
2168 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2169 used Libwurfl API version.
2170
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002171 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2172 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2173
2174 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2175 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2176
2177 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2178
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002179 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002180 with USE_WURFL=1.
2181
2182wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2183 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2184 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2185
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002186 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002187 with USE_WURFL=1.
2188
2189wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2190 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2191 thus before the chroot.
2192
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002193 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002194 with USE_WURFL=1.
2195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021963.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002197-----------------------
2198
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002199busy-polling
2200 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2201 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2202 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2203 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2204 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2205 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2206 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2207 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2208 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2209 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2210 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2211 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2212 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2213 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2214 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2215 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2216 "poll" pollers.
2217
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002218 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2219 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2220 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2221
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002222max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002223 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002224 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2225 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2226 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2227 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2228 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2229 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2230 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2231
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002232maxcompcpuusage <number>
2233 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2234 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2235 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2236 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2237 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2238 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2239 and from introducing high latencies.
2240
2241maxcomprate <number>
2242 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2243 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2244 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2245 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2246 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2247 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2248 default value.
2249
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002250maxconn <number>
2251 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2252 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2253 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002254 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2255 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2256 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2257 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002258 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2259 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2260 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2261 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2262 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2263 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002264
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002265maxconnrate <number>
2266 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2267 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2268 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2269 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2270 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2271 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2272 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2273 fairness.
2274
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002275maxpipes <number>
2276 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2277 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2278 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2279 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2280 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2281 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2282
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002283maxsessrate <number>
2284 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2285 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2286 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2287 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2288 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2289 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2290 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2291 fairness.
2292
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002293maxsslconn <number>
2294 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2295 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2296 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2297 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2298 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2299 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2300 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002301 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2302 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2303 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2304 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002305 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002306 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2307 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002308
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002309maxsslrate <number>
2310 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2311 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2312 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2313 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2314 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2315 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2316 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2317 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2318 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2319 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2320
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002321maxzlibmem <number>
2322 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2323 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2324 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002325 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2326 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2327 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2328
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002329no-memory-trimming
2330 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2331 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2332 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2333 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2334 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2335 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2336 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2337 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2338 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2339 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2340 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2341 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2342 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2343 not suffer from such a problem.
2344
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002345noepoll
2346 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2347 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002348 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002349
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002350noevports
2351 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2352 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2353 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2354 also "nopoll".
2355
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002356nogetaddrinfo
2357 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2358 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2359
2360nokqueue
2361 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2362 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2363 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2364
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002365nopoll
2366 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2367 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002368 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002369 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2370 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002371
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002372noreuseport
2373 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2374 command line argument "-dR".
2375
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002376nosplice
2377 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002378 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002379 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002380 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002381 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2382 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2383 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2384 "option splice-response".
2385
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002386profiling.memory { on | off }
2387 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2388 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2389 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2390 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2391 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2392 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2393 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2394 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2395 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2396
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002397profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2398 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2399 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2400 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2401 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002402 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002403 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2404 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2405 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2406 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2407
2408 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2409 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2410 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2411 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2412 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002413 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2414 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2415 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2416 CLI.
2417
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002418spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002419 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2420 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2421 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2422 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2423 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2424 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002425
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002426ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002427 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002428 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002429 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002430 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002431 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2432 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2433 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002434 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2435 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002436 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2437 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2438 openssl configuration file uses:
2439 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2440
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002441ssl-mode-async
2442 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002443 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002444 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2445 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002446 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002447 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002448 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002449
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002450tune.buffers.limit <number>
2451 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2452 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2453 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2454 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2455 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002456 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002457 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2458 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2459 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2460 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2461 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2462 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2463 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2464 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002465 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002466
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002467tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2468 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2469 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2470 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002471 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002472
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002473tune.bufsize <number>
2474 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2475 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2476 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2477 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2478 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2479 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2480 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002481 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2482 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002483 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002484 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002485 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002486 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2487 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002488
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002489tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2490 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002491
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002492tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2493 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2494 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2495 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2496 this value. The default value is 1.
2497
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002498tune.fail-alloc
2499 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2500 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2501 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2502 gracefully.
2503
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002504tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2505 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2506 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2507 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2508 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2509 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2510
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002511tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2512 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2513 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2514 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2515 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2516 change it.
2517
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002518tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2519 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002520 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002521 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002522 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2523 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2524 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2525 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2526 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2527
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002528tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2529 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2530 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2531 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2532 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2533 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002534 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002535 recommended not to change this value.
2536
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002537tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002538 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002539 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002540 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002541 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2542 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2543 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2544 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2545
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002546tune.http.cookielen <number>
2547 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2548 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2549 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2550 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2551 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2552 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2553 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2554 to change this value.
2555
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002556tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002557 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2558 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002559 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002560 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002561 configuration directives too.
2562 The default value is 1024.
2563
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002564tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2565 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2566 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2567 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2568 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2569 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2570 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002571 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2572 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2573 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002574
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002575tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2576 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2577 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2578 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2579 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2580 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2581 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002582 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2583 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2584 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2585 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2586 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002587
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002588tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002589 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002590 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2591 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2592 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2593 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002594 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002595 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002596 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002597 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2598
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002599tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2600 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2601 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2602 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2603 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2604 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2605 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2606 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2607 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2608 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2609
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002610tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2611 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002612 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002613 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2614 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002615 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002616 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2617 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2618
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002619tune.lua.maxmem
2620 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2621 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2622 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2623 memory.
2624
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002625tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2626 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002627 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2628 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002629 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002630
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002631tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2632 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2633 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2634 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002635 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002636
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002637tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2638 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2639 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2640 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2641 check servers.
2642
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002643tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002644 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2645 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002646 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2647 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2648 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2649 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2650 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2651 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2652 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2653 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2654 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002655
2656tune.maxpollevents <number>
2657 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2658 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2659 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2660 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2661 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2662
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002663tune.maxrewrite <number>
2664 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2665 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2666 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2667 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2668 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2669 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2670 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2671 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2672 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2673 bufsize.
2674
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002675tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2676 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2677 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2678 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2679 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2680 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2681 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2682 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2683 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2684 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002685 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2686 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002687 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2688 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2689 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2690 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2691 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2692 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2693 setting this parameter to 0.
2694
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002695tune.pipesize <number>
2696 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2697 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2698 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2699 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2700 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2701 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2702
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002703tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2704 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002705 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002706 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2707 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2708 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2709 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002710 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002711
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002712tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2713 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002714 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002715 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2716 default is 20.
2717
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002718tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2719tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2720 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2721 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2722 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002723 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002724 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002725 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2726 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2727
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002728tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002729 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002730 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2731 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2732 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2733 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2734
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002735tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002736 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002737 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2738 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2739 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2740 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2741 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2742 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2743 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002744
2745tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2746 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002747 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002748 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2749 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2750 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2751 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2752 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2753 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2754 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002755
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002756tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2757tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2758 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2759 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2760 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002761 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002762 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002763 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2764 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2765 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2766 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002767 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002768
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002769tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002770 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002771 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2772 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2773 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2774 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2775 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2776 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2777 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2778 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2779 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2780 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2781 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002782
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002783tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2784 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2785 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2786 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2787 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2788
2789tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2790 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2791 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2792 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2793 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2794 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2795 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2796 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2797 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2798 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2799 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2800 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2801 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2802
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002803tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002804 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002805 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2806 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2807 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2808 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2809 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2810
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002811tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2812 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2813 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2814 performances. This is disabled by default.
2815
2816 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2817 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2818
2819 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2820
2821 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2822
2823 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2824
2825 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2826 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2827 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2828
2829 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2830 converted.
2831
2832 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2833 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2834 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2835 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2836 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2837 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2838 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002839 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2840 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002841
2842 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2843
2844 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2845 only need this line:
2846
2847 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2848
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002849tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2850 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002851 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002852 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2853 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2854 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2855 being used for too long.
2856
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002857tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2858 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2859 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2860 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2861 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2862 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2863 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2864 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2865 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2866 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2867 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002868 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002869 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002870
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002871tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2872 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2873 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2874 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2875 1000 entries.
2876
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002877tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002878tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002879tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2880tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2881tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002882 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2883 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2884 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2885 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2886 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2887 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2888 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2889 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002890
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002891 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2892 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2893 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2894 all available space is consumed.
2895 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2896 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2897 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002898
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002899tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2900 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002901 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002902 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002903 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002904 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2905
2906tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2907 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2908 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002909 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2910 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029123.3. Debugging
2913--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002915quiet
2916 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2917 line argument "-q".
2918
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002919zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002920 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002921 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2922 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2923 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2924 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2925 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2926
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029283.4. Userlists
2929--------------
2930It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2931http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2932it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2933
2934userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002935 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002936 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2937
2938group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002939 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002940 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2941 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2942
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002943user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2944 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002945 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2946 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002947 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2948 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2949 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2950 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002952 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2953 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2954 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2955 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2956 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2957 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2958 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002959 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002960 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002961
2962 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002963 userlist L1
2964 group G1 users tiger,scott
2965 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002966
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002967 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2968 user scott insecure-password elgato
2969 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002970
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002971 userlist L2
2972 group G1
2973 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002974
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002975 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2976 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2977 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002978
2979 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002980
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981
29823.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002983----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002984It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002985several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002986instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2987values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2988automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2989In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2990using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2991tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2992reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2993Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2994that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2995each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002996
2997peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002998 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002999 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3000
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003001bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3002bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003003 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3004 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3005
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003006disabled
3007 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3008 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3009 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3010
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003011default-bind [param*]
3012 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3013
3014default-server [param*]
3015 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3016
3017 Arguments:
3018 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3019 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003020 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3021 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3022 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3023 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003024
3025 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3026
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003027enabled
3028 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3029 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003030
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003031log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003032 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3033 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3034 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3035 more details.
3036
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003037peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3038peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003039 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3040 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003041 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003042 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3043 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3044 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003045 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003046
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003047 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003048 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3049
3050 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003051 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3052 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3053 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003054
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003055 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3056 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003057
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003058 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3059 "server" keyword explanation below).
3060
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003061server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3062server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003063 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003064 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003065 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3066 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3067 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003068
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003069 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3070 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3071 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3072 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3073 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003074
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003075 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003076 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003077 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003078 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3079 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3080 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003081
3082 backend mybackend
3083 mode tcp
3084 balance roundrobin
3085 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3086 stick on src
3087
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003088 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3089 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003090
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003091 Example:
3092 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003093 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3094 default-server ssl verify none
3095 server haproxy1 #local peer
3096 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3097 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003098
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003099
3100table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3101 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3102
3103 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3104 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003105 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003106 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3107 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3108 "stick-table" keyword).
3109
3110 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3111 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3112 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3113 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3114 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3115 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3116 of the stick-table name as follows:
3117
3118 peers mypeers
3119 peer A ...
3120 peer B ...
3121 table t1 ...
3122
3123 frontend fe1
3124 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3125
3126 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3127 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3128
3129 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3130 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3131 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3132 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3133 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3134 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3135 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3136
3137 peers mypeers
3138 peer A ...
3139 peer B ...
3140 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3141
3142 backend t1
3143 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3144
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003145 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003146 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3147 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3148
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031493.6. Mailers
3150------------
3151It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3152If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3153in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3154
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003155mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003156 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3157 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3158
3159mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3160 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3161
3162 Example:
3163 mailers mymailers
3164 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3165 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3166
3167 backend mybackend
3168 mode tcp
3169 balance roundrobin
3170
3171 email-alert mailers mymailers
3172 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3173 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3174
3175 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3176 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3177
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003178timeout mail <time>
3179 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3180 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3181 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3182 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3183
3184 Example:
3185 mailers mymailers
3186 timeout mail 20s
3187 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003188
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031893.7. Programs
3190-------------
3191In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3192master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3193managed the same way as the workers.
3194
3195During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3196sequence as a worker:
3197
3198 - the master is re-executed
3199 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3200 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3201 instance of the program
3202
3203During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3204
3205program <name>
3206 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3207 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3208 the management guide).
3209
3210command <command> [arguments*]
3211 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3212 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3213 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3214 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3215
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003216user <user name>
3217 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3218 See also "group".
3219
3220group <group name>
3221 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3222 See also "user".
3223
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003224option start-on-reload
3225no option start-on-reload
3226 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3227 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3228 program section.
3229
3230
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032313.8. HTTP-errors
3232----------------
3233
3234It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3235imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3236several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3237
3238http-errors <name>
3239 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3240 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3241
3242errorfile <code> <file>
3243 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3244
3245 Arguments :
3246 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003247 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003248 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003249
3250 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3251 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3252 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3253 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3254 before any chroot is performed.
3255
3256 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3257
3258 Example:
3259 http-errors website-1
3260 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3261 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3262 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3263
3264 http-errors website-2
3265 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3266 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3267 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3268
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032693.9. Rings
3270----------
3271
3272It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3273servers or traces.
3274
3275ring <ringname>
3276 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3277
3278description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003279 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003280 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3281
3282format <format>
3283 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3284
3285 Arguments:
3286 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3287 one of the following :
3288
3289 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3290 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3291 designed to be used with a local log server.
3292
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003293 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3294 field is stripped. This is the default.
3295 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3296 rfc3164.
3297
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003298 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3299 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3300 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3301 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3302 is the default.
3303
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003304 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003305 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3306
3307 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3308 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3309
3310 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3311 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3312 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3313 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3314 logger consumes.
3315
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003316 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3317 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3318 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3319 with a local log server.
3320
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003321 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3322 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3323 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3324 used with a local log server.
3325
3326maxlen <length>
3327 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3328 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3329 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3330
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003331server <name> <address> [param*]
3332 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3333 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3334 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3335 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3336 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3337 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3338 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3339 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3340 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003341 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3342 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003343
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003344size <size>
3345 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3346 set to BUFSIZE.
3347
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003348timeout connect <timeout>
3349 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3350
3351 Arguments :
3352 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3353 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3354 as explained at the top of this document.
3355
3356timeout server <timeout>
3357 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3358
3359 Arguments :
3360 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3361 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3362 as explained at the top of this document.
3363
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003364 Example:
3365 global
3366 log ring@myring local7
3367
3368 ring myring
3369 description "My local buffer"
3370 format rfc3164
3371 maxlen 1200
3372 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003373 timeout connect 5s
3374 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003375 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003376
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033773.10. Log forwarding
3378-------------------
3379
3380It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003381HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003382
3383log-forward <name>
3384 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3385
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003386backlog <conns>
3387 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3388 on connections accept.
3389
3390bind <addr> [param*]
3391 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003392 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3393 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3394 syslog protocol over TCP.
3395 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003396 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3397
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003398dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003399 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3400 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3401 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3402 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003403 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003404
3405log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003406log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003407 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3408 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3409 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003410 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003411 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3412 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3413 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003414 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003415
3416 Example:
3417 global
3418 log stderr format iso local7
3419
3420 ring myring
3421 description "My local buffer"
3422 format rfc5424
3423 maxlen 1200
3424 size 32764
3425 timeout connect 5s
3426 timeout server 10s
3427 # syslog tcp server
3428 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3429
3430 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003431 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3432 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003433 # all messages on stderr
3434 log global
3435 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3436 log ring@myring local0
3437 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3438 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3439 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3440 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3441 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003442
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003443maxconn <conns>
3444 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3445 10 is the default.
3446
3447timeout client <timeout>
3448 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034504. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003451----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003453Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003454 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3455 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3456 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3457 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003458
3459A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3460connections.
3461
3462A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3463to forward incoming connections.
3464
3465A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3466parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3467
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003468A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3469ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3470sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3471the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3472explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3473from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3474"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3475for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3476to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3477optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3478are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3479any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3480names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3481that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3482duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3483names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3484
3485Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3486settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3487of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3488profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3489timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003491All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3492'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3493case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3494
3495Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3496logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3497proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3498However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3499name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3500
3501Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3502and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003503bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003504protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3505modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3506arbitrary criteria.
3507
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003508In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3509a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003510the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003511
3512 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3513 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3514 between responses and new requests.
3515
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003516 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3517 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3518 client-facing connection remains open.
3519
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003520 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3521 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003522
3523The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3524frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3525following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003526weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003527
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003528 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003529
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003530 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3531 ----+-----+-----+----
3532 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3533 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003534 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3535 ----+-----+-----+----
3536 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003537
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003538It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003539only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3540within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003541as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003542content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003543and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3544possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003546There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003547first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003548processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003549second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003550protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3551is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3552new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003553to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003554process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3555already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3556HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3557evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3558one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3559
3560There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3561performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3562tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3563preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3564analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3565HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3566header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3567mitigate this drawback.
3568
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003569There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003570method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3571set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3572in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3573is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3574to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3575above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3576to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3577"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3578frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3579frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3580as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3581upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3582on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3583the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3584upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3585frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3586remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035884.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3589--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003591The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3592limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3593they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3594limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003595marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003596option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003597and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3598with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3599specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003601
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3603------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3604acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605backlog X X X -
3606balance X - X X
3607bind - X X -
3608bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003609capture cookie - X X -
3610capture request header - X X -
3611capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003612clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3613clitcpka-idle X X X -
3614clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003615compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003616cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003617declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003618default-server X - X X
3619default_backend X X X -
3620description - X X X
3621disabled X X X X
3622dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003623email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003624email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003625email-alert mailers X X X X
3626email-alert myhostname X X X X
3627email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628enabled X X X X
3629errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003630errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631errorloc X X X X
3632errorloc302 X X X X
3633-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3634errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003635force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003636filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003637fullconn X - X X
3638grace X X X X
3639hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003640http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003641http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003642http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003644http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003645http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003646http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003647http-check set-var X - X X
3648http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003649http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003651http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003652http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON17e3cd52023-01-12 15:59:27 +01003653http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003655ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003656load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003657log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003658log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003659log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003660log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003661max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON59f36bc2023-11-29 10:13:18 +01003662max-session-srv-conns X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003663maxconn X X X -
3664mode X X X X
3665monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003666monitor-uri X X X -
3667option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3668option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3669option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3670option allbackups (*) X - X X
3671option checkcache (*) X - X X
3672option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3673option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003674option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003675option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3676option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003677-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3678option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003679option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3680option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003681option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003682option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003683option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003684option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003685option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003686option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003687option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3688option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3689option httpchk X - X X
3690option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003691option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003692option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003693option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003694option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003695option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3697option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3698option logasap (*) X X X -
3699option mysql-check X - X X
3700option nolinger (*) X X X X
3701option originalto X X X X
3702option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003703option pgsql-check X - X X
3704option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003706option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003707option smtpchk X - X X
3708option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3709option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3710option splice-request (*) X X X X
3711option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01003712option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003713option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3714option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3715-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003716option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003717option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3718option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3719option tcpka X X X X
3720option tcplog X X X X
3721option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003722option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003723external-check command X - X X
3724external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003725persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3726rate-limit sessions X X X -
3727redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003728-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003729retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003730retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003731server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003732server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003733server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003734source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003735srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3736srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3737srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003738stats admin - X X X
3739stats auth X X X X
3740stats enable X X X X
3741stats hide-version X X X X
3742stats http-request - X X X
3743stats realm X X X X
3744stats refresh X X X X
3745stats scope X X X X
3746stats show-desc X X X X
3747stats show-legends X X X X
3748stats show-node X X X X
3749stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003750-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3751stick match - - X X
3752stick on - - X X
3753stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003754stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003755stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003756tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003757tcp-check connect X - X X
3758tcp-check expect X - X X
3759tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003760tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003761tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003762tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003763tcp-check set-var X - X X
3764tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003765tcp-request connection - X X -
3766tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003767tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003768tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003769tcp-response content - - X X
3770tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003771timeout check X - X X
3772timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003773timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003774timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003775timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3776timeout http-request X X X X
3777timeout queue X - X X
3778timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003779timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003780timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003781timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003782transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003783unique-id-format X X X -
3784unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003785use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003786use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003787use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003788------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3789 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3793---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003794
3795This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3796
3797
3798acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3799 Declare or complete an access list.
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 no | yes | yes | yes
3802 Example:
3803 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3804 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3805 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003807 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808
3809
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003810backlog <conns>
3811 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3813 yes | yes | yes | no
3814 Arguments :
3815 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3816 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003817 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003818
3819 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3820 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3821 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3822 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3823 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3824 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3825 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3826 backlog parameter.
3827
3828 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3829 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3830 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3831
3832 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3833
3834
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003836balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003837 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | no | yes | yes
3840 Arguments :
3841 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3842 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3843 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3844 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3845
3846 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3847 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3848 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3849 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003850 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003851 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003852 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3853 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3854 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3855 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3856 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3857 it, so that you don't worry.
3858
3859 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3860 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3861 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3862 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3863 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3864 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3865 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3866 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003867
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003868 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3869 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3870 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3871 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3872 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3873 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3874 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003875 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3876 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3877 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003878
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003879 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003880 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003881 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3882 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003883 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003884 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3885 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3886 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3887 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3888 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003889 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3890 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3891 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3892 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3893 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3894 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003896 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3897 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3898 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3899 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3900 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3901 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3902 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3903 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003904 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003905 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003906 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3907 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3908 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003909
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003910 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3911 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3912 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3913 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3914 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3915 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3916 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3917 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3918 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3919 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3920 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3921 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003922
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003923 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003924 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3925 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3926 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3927 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3928 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3929 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3930 URIs start with a leading "/".
3931
3932 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3933 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3934 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3935 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3936
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003937 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3938 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3939 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3940 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3941
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003942 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003943 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3944
3945 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003946 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3947 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003948 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3949 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3950 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3951 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003952 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003953 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3954 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003955
3956 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3957 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3958 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3959 server will receive the request.
3960
3961 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3962 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3963 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3964 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3965 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003966 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3967 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3968 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003969
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003970 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3971 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3972 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3973 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3974 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003976 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003977 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3978 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3979 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3980
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003981 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3982 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3983 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3984
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003985 random
3986 random(<draws>)
3987 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003988 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3989 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3990 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3991 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003992 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3993 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3994 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3995 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3996 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3997 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3998 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3999 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4000 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4001 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4002 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4003 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4004 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4005 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4006 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4007 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4008 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4009 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4010 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4011 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004012
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004013 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004014 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004015 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4016 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004017 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004018 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4019 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4020 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004021 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004022 used instead.
4023
4024 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4025 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4026 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004027 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004028
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004029 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4030 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4031 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004033 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004034 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4035 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004036
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004037 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4038 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4039 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004040
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004041 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004042 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004043 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4044 NTLM relies on.
4045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004046 Examples :
4047 balance roundrobin
4048 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004049 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004050 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4051 balance hdr(host)
4052 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004053
4054 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4055 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004057 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004058 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4059 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4060 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004061 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004062
4063 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4064 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4065 defaults to 16 kB.
4066
4067 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4068 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4069
4070 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4071 Round Robin.
4072
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004073 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004074 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4075 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4076 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4077
4078 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4079
4080 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004081 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004082 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4083 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4084 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004085
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004086 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004087
4088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004089bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4090bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004091 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4093 no | yes | yes | no
4094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004095 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4096 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4097 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4098 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004099 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004100 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4101 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4102 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4103 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4104 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4105 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004106 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004107 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4108 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004109 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004110 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4111 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004112 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004113 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4114 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004115 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004116 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4117 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4118 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4119 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4120 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4121 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4122 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004123 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4124 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4125 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004126 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4127 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4128 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4129 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004130 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4131 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4132 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004133
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004134 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4135 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004136 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4137 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4138 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004139 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4140 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4141 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4142 the range.
4143
4144 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4145 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4146 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4147 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4148 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4149 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4150 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004151 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004152 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004153
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004154 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004155 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004156 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4157 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4158 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4159 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4160 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4161 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4162
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004163 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4164 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4165 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4166 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4169 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4170 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4171 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4172 in a frontend.
4173
4174 Example :
4175 listen http_proxy
4176 bind :80,:443
4177 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004178 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004179
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004180 listen http_https_proxy
4181 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004182 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004183
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004184 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4185 bind ipv6@:80
4186 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4187 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4188
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004189 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004190 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004191
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004192 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4193 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4194 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4195 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4196 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4197
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004198 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004199 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004200
4201
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004202bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004203 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4205 yes | yes | yes | yes
4206 Arguments :
4207 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4208 may be used to override a default value.
4209
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004210 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004211 option may be combined with other numbers.
4212
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004213 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004214 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4215 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4216 missing from all processes.
4217
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004218 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004219 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004220 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4221 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4222 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4223 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4224 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004225 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004226
4227 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4228 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4229 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4230 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4231 and 'even' instances.
4232
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004233 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4234 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4235 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4236 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004237
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004238 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4239 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4240
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004241 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4242 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4243 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4244
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004245 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4246 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4247
4248 Example :
4249 listen app_ip1
4250 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004251 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004252
4253 listen app_ip2
4254 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004255 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004256
4257 listen management
4258 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004259 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004260
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004261 listen management
4262 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4263 bind-process 1-4
4264
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004265 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004266
4267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004268capture cookie <name> len <length>
4269 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 no | yes | yes | no
4272 Arguments :
4273 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4274 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4275 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4276 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004277 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
4279 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4280 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4281 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4282 right if it exceeds <length>.
4283
4284 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4285 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4286 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4287 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4288
4289 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4290 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4291 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4292
4293 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4294 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4295 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004296 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4297 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4298 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004299
4300 Example:
4301 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4302
4303 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004304 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004305
4306
4307capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004308 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4310 no | yes | yes | no
4311 Arguments :
4312 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004313 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004314 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4315 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4316 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4317
4318 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4319 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4320 it exceeds <length>.
4321
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004322 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004323 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4324 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004325 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4326 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4327 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4328 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004329 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004330 environments to find where the request came from.
4331
4332 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4333 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4334 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4335 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004337 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4338 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4339 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4340 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4341 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004342
4343 Example:
4344 capture request header Host len 15
4345 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004346 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004348 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349 about logging.
4350
4351
4352capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004353 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4355 no | yes | yes | no
4356 Arguments :
4357 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004358 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004359 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4360 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4361 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4362
4363 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4364 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4365 it exceeds <length>.
4366
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004367 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004368 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4369 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4370 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004371 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4372 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4373 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4374 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004375
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004376 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4377 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4378 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4379 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4380 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004381
4382 Example:
4383 capture response header Content-length len 9
4384 capture response header Location len 15
4385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004386 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004387 about logging.
4388
4389
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004390clitcpka-cnt <count>
4391 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4392 the connection on the client side.
4393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4394 yes | yes | yes | no
4395 Arguments :
4396 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4397
4398 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4399 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004400 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4401 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004402
4403 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4404
4405
4406clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4407 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4408 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4409 client side.
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | yes | yes | no
4412 Arguments :
4413 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4414 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4415 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4416 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4417
4418 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4419 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004420 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4421 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004422
4423 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4424
4425
4426clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4427 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4429 yes | yes | yes | no
4430 Arguments :
4431 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4432 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4433 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4434 document.
4435
4436 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4437 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004438 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4439 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004440
4441 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4442
4443
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004444compression algo <algorithm> ...
4445compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004446compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004447 Enable HTTP compression.
4448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4449 yes | yes | yes | yes
4450 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004451 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4452 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004453 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004454
4455 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004456 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4457 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4458 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004459
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004460 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004461 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004462
4463 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4464 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4465 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4466 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4467 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004468 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004469
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004470 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4471 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4472 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4473 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4474 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4475 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4476 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004477 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004478
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004479 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004480 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004481 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004482 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004483 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004484 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004485 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004486
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004487 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004488 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4489 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004490 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4491 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004492 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004493 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004494 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4495 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004496 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004497 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4498 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004499
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004500 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004501 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4502 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004503 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004504 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004505 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4506 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4507 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4508 "multipart"
4509 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4510 header
4511 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4512 and later
4513 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4514 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004515 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004516
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004517 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004518
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004519 Examples :
4520 compression algo gzip
4521 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004522
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004523
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004524cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004525 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4526 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004527 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004528 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4530 yes | no | yes | yes
4531 Arguments :
4532 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4533 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4534 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4535 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4536 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4537 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004538 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004539 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4540 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4541
4542 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004543 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004544 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4545 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4546 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4547 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004548 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4549 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004550 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004551 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4552 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004553
4554 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004555 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004556
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004557 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004558 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004559 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004560 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004561 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4562 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4563 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4564 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4565 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4566 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4567 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004568
4569 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4570 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4571 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4572 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4573 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4574 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4575 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4576 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4577 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004578 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004579 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4580 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4581 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004582
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004583 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4584 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4585 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004586 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4587 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4588 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4589 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004590 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4591 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4592 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004593
4594 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4595 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4596 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4597 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4598 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4599 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4600 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4601 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4602 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4603
4604 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4605 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4606 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4607 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4608 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4609 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4610 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4611 persistence cookie in the cache.
4612 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4613
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004614 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4615 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004616 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004617 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4618 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004619 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004620 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4621 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4622 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4623 they logout.
4624
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004625 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004626 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4627 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4628 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4629
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004630 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004631 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4632 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4633 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4634 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4635 this attribute.
4636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004637 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004638 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004639 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4640 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4641 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4642 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4643 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4644 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004645
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004646 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4647 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4648 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4649 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4650 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4651 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4652 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4653 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004654 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004655 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4656 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4657 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4658 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4659 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4660 the site.
4661
4662 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4663 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4664 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4665 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4666 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4667 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4668 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4669 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4670 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4671 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4672 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4673 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4674 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004675 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004676 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4677 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4678
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004679 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4680 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4681 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4682 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4683 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4684 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4685
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004686 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004687 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4688 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4689 repeated.
4690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004691 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4692 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4693 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4694 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004696 Examples :
4697 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4698 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4699 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004700 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004701
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004702 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004703
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004704
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004705declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4706 Declares a capture slot.
4707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 no | yes | yes | no
4709 Arguments:
4710 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4711
4712 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4713 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4714 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4715 for use in the response.
4716
4717 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004718 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004719 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4720
4721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004722default-server [param*]
4723 Change default options for a server in a backend
4724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4725 yes | no | yes | yes
4726 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004727 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4728 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4729 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4730 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004731
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004732 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004733 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4734
4735 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004736
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004737
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004738default_backend <backend>
4739 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | yes | yes | no
4742 Arguments :
4743 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4744
4745 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4746 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4747 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4748 will catch all undetermined requests.
4749
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004750 Example :
4751
4752 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4753 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4754 default_backend dynamic
4755
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004756 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004758
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004759description <string>
4760 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4762 no | yes | yes | yes
4763 Arguments : string
4764
4765 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4766 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4767 it describes.
4768 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4769
4770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004771disabled
4772 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4774 yes | yes | yes | yes
4775 Arguments : none
4776
4777 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4778 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4779 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4780 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4781 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4782 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4783 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4784
4785 See also : "enabled"
4786
4787
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004788dispatch <address>:<port>
4789 Set a default server address
4790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4791 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004792 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004793
4794 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4795 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4796 during start-up.
4797
4798 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4799 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4800 possible with normal servers.
4801
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004802 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004803 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4804 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4805 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4806 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4807
4808 See also : "server"
4809
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004810
4811dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4812 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4814 yes | no | yes | yes
4815 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4816
4817 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004818 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004819 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4820 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004821 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004822 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004823
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004824enabled
4825 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4827 yes | yes | yes | yes
4828 Arguments : none
4829
4830 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4831 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4832
4833 See also : "disabled"
4834
4835
4836errorfile <code> <file>
4837 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4839 yes | yes | yes | yes
4840 Arguments :
4841 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004842 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004843 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844
4845 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004846 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004847 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004848 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4849 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004850
4851 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4852 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4853 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4854
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004855 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4856
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004857 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4858 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4859 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4860 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4861 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4862 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4863 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4864 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4865 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004867 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4868 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4869 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004870 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004871 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4872
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004873 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004874
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004875 Example :
4876 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004877 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004878 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4879 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4880
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004881
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004882errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4883 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4884 section.
4885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4886 yes | yes | yes | yes
4887 Arguments :
4888 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4889
4890 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004891 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004892 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4893 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004894
4895 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4896 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4897 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4898 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4899 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004900 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004901 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4902
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004903 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4904 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004905
4906 Example :
4907 errorfiles generic
4908 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4909
4910
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004911errorloc <code> <url>
4912errorloc302 <code> <url>
4913 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 yes | yes | yes | yes
4916 Arguments :
4917 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004918 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004919 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004920
4921 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4922 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4923 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4924 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004925 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926
4927 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4928 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4929 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4930
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004931 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4932
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004933 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4934 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4935 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4936 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004937 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4939 request.
4940
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004941 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004942
4943
4944errorloc303 <code> <url>
4945 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4947 yes | yes | yes | yes
4948 Arguments :
4949 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004950 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004951 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004952
4953 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4954 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4955 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4956 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004957 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004958
4959 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4960 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4961 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4962
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004963 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4964
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004965 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4966 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4967 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4968 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004969 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004970
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004971 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004972
4973
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004974email-alert from <emailaddr>
4975 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004976 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004977 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | yes | yes | yes
4979
4980 Arguments :
4981
4982 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4983
4984 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4985 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4986
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004987 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004988 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4989 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004990
4991
4992email-alert level <level>
4993 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4994 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4996 yes | yes | yes | yes
4997
4998 Arguments :
4999
5000 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5001 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5002 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5003
5004 By default level is alert
5005
5006 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5007 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5008 for the proxy.
5009
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005010 Alerts are sent when :
5011
5012 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5013 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5014 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5015 is notice or lower
5016 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5017 and a health check status update occurs
5018
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005019 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5020 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005021 section 3.6 about mailers.
5022
5023
5024email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5025 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5026 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 yes | yes | yes | yes
5028
5029 Arguments :
5030
5031 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5032
5033 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5034 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5035
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005036 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5037 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005038
5039
5040email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5041 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5042 mailers.
5043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5044 yes | yes | yes | yes
5045
5046 Arguments :
5047
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005048 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005049
5050 By default the systems hostname is used.
5051
5052 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5053 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5054 for the proxy.
5055
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005056 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5057 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005058
5059
5060email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005061 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005062 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5063 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 yes | yes | yes | yes
5065
5066 Arguments :
5067
5068 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5069
5070 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5071 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5072
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005073 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005074 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5075
5076
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005077force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5078 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5079 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005080 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005081
5082 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5083 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5084 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5085 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5086 marked down for maintenance operations.
5087
5088 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5089 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5090 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5091 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5092 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5093 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5094 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5095 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5096 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5097
5098 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5099 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5100 is used.
5101
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005102 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005103 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005104
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005105
5106filter <name> [param*]
5107 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5109 no | yes | yes | yes
5110 Arguments :
5111 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5112 referenced in section 9.
5113
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005114 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005115 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005116 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5117 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005118
5119 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5120 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5121
5122 Example:
5123 listen
5124 bind *:80
5125
5126 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5127 filter compression
5128 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5129
5130 compression algo gzip
5131 compression offload
5132
5133 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5134
5135 See also : section 9.
5136
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005137
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005138fullconn <conns>
5139 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5141 yes | no | yes | yes
5142 Arguments :
5143 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5144 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5145
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005146 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005147 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005148 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005149 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5150 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5151 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5152 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5153 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005154 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005155
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005156 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005157 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005158 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5159 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5160 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005161
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005162 Example :
5163 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5164 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5165 # connections.
5166 backend dynamic
5167 fullconn 10000
5168 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5169 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5170
5171 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5172
5173
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005174grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005175 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005177 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005178 Arguments :
5179 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5180 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5181 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5182
5183 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5184 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005185 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005186 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5187
5188 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5189 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5190 simplify it.
5191
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005192
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005193hash-balance-factor <factor>
5194 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5196 yes | no | no | yes
5197 Arguments :
5198 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5199 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005200 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005201
5202 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5203 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5204 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5205 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5206 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5207 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5208 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5209
5210 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5211 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5212 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5213 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5214 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5215
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005216 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5217 consistent hashing mechanism.
5218
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005219 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5220
5221
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005222hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005223 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5225 yes | no | yes | yes
5226 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005227 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5228 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005229
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005230 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5231 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5232 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5233 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5234 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5235 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5236 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5237 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5238 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5239 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005240
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005241 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5242 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5243 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5244 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5245 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5246 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5247 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5248 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5249 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5250 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5251 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5252 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5253 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005254 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5255 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005256
5257 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5258
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005259 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005260 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5261 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5262 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005263 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5264 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5265 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005266
5267 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5268 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005269 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5270 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5271 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5272 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5273
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005274 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005275 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5276 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5277 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5278 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5279 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5280 parameter.
5281
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005282 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5283 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5284 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5285 used on strings.
5286
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005287 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5288
5289 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5290 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5291 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5292 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5293 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5294 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5295 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5296 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5297 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5298 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5299 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5300 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005301
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005302 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5303 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5304 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005305
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005306 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005307
5308
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005309http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5310 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5311 ones).
5312
5313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5314 no | yes | yes | yes
5315
5316 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5317 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5318 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5319 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5320 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5321 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5322
5323 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5324 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5325 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5326
5327 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5328 below.
5329
5330 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5331 instance.
5332
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005333 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5334 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5335 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5336
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005337 Example:
5338 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5339 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5340 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5341
5342http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5343
5344 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5345 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5346 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5347 example, or to pass some internal information.
5348 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5349 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5350 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5351
5352http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5353
5354 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5355 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5356
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005357http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005358
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005359 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5360 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5361 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5362 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5363 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005364
5365http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5367
5368 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5369
5370 Example:
5371 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5372
5373 # applied to:
5374 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5375
5376 # outputs:
5377 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5378
5379 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5380
5381http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5382 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5383
5384 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5385
5386 Example:
5387 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5388
5389 # applied to:
5390 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5391
5392 # outputs:
5393 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5394
5395http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5396
5397 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5398 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5399 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5400
5401http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5402 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5403
5404 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5405 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5406 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5407 fallback.
5408
5409 Example:
5410 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5411 http-response set-status 431
5412 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5413 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5414
5415http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5416
5417 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5418 inline.
5419
5420 Arguments:
5421 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5422 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5423 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5424 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5425 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5426 (request and response)
5427 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5428 processing
5429 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5430 processing
5431 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5432 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5433 and '_'.
5434
5435 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5436 followed by some converters.
5437
5438 Example:
5439 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5440
5441http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5442
5443 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5444 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5445 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5446 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5447 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005448 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005449 processing.
5450
5451 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5452 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005453 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005454 rules evaluation.
5455
5456http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5457
5458 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5459 details about <var-name>.
5460
5461 Example:
5462 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5463
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005464
5465http-check comment <string>
5466 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5467 it fails.
5468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5469 yes | no | yes | yes
5470
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005471 Arguments :
5472 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5473 rule fails.
5474
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005475 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5476 user-friendly error reporting.
5477
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005478 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005479 "http-check expect".
5480
5481
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005482http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5483 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005484 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005485 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5487 yes | no | yes | yes
5488
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005489 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005490 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5491
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005492 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005493 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005494
5495 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5496 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5497 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5498 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5499
5500 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5501
5502 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5503
5504 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5505
5506 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5507
5508 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5509
5510 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5511 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5512 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5513 is used.
5514
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005515 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5516 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5517 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5518 haproxy -vv.
5519
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005520 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5521
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005522 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5523 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5524 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5525 different ports or with different servers.
5526
5527 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5528 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5529 the port with a "http-check connect".
5530
5531 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5532 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5533 do.
5534
5535 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5536 unset-var or comment rules.
5537
5538 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005539 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5540 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5541 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5542 option httpchk
5543
5544 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005545 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005546 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005547 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005548 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005549 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005550
5551 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5552
5553 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005554
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005556http-check disable-on-404
5557 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005559 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005560 Arguments : none
5561
5562 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5563 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5564 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5565 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5566 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5567 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5568 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5569 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005570 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5571 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005572 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5573 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5574 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005575
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005576 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005577
5578
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005579http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005580 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5581 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5582 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005583 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005585 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005586
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005587 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005588 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5589
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005590 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5591 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5592 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5593 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5594 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5595 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5596 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5597 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5598 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5599 result is always conclusive.
5600
5601 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5602 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5603 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005604 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5605 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005606 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5607 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005608 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5609 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5610 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005611
5612 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5613 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005614 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5615 supported :
5616 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5617 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005618 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5619 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5620 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5621 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5622 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005623
5624 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5625 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005626 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5627 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5628 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5629 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005630 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5631
5632 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5633 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5634 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5635 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5636
5637 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5638 informational message reported in logs if an error
5639 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5640 log-format string.
5641
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005642 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005643 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5644 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005645 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5646 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5647 details on the supported keywords.
5648
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005649 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5650 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5651 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5652 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005653
5654 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5655 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5656 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5657 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5658 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5659
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005660 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5661 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5662 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5663 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5664 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5665 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5666 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005667
5668 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005669 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005670 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5671 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5672 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5673 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5674
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005675 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5676 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005677 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5678 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5679 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5680 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5681 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5682 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5683 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5684 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005685 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5686 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5687 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5688 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5689 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5690 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5691 insensitive on the header names.
5692
5693 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5694 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5695 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5696 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5697 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5698 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005699
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005700 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005701 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005702 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5703 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5704 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5705 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5706 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005707 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005708 trace).
5709
5710 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005711 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005712 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5713 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5714 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5715 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5716 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005717 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005718
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005719 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5720 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5721 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5722 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5723 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5724 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5725
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005726 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005727 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005728 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5729 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5730 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5731 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5732 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5733 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5734
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005735 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5736 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5737 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5738 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5739 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005740
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005741 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5742 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5743
5744 Examples :
5745 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005746 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005747
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005748 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5749 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5750
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005751 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005752 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005753
5754 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005755 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005756
5757 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005758 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005759
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005760 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005761 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005762
5763
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005764http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005765 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5766 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005767 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5768 health checks.
5769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5770 yes | no | yes | yes
5771 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005772 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5773
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005774 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5775 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5776 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5777 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5778 to invent non-standard ones.
5779
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005780 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5781 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5782 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5783 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5784
5785 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5786 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5787 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5788 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005789
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005790 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005791 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005792 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005793 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5794 to add it.
5795
5796 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5797 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5798 to the log-format rules.
5799
5800 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5801 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5802 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005803
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005804 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5805 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5806 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5807 request.
5808
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005809 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5810 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5811 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005812 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5813 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5814 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5815 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005816 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005817
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005818 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005819 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5820 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005821
5822 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5823 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5824 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5825 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5826 configured request authority.
5827
5828 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5829 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005830
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005831 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005832
5833
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005834http-check send-state
5835 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5837 yes | no | yes | yes
5838 Arguments : none
5839
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005840 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005841 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005842 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5843 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5844 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005845
5846 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5847 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5848 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5849 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5850 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005851 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5852 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5853 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5854
5855 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5856 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5857 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5858
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005859 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5860 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5861 checked in multiple backends.
5862
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005863 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005864 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5865
5866 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5867 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5868 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5869 one fails.
5870
5871 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5872 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5873 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5874
5875 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5876 server's queue.
5877
5878 Example of a header received by the application server :
5879 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5880 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5881
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005882 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5883 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005884
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005885
5886http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005887 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5889 yes | no | yes | yes
5890
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005891 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005892 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5893 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5894 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5895 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5896 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5897 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5898 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5899 and '-'.
5900
5901 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5902
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005903 Examples :
5904 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005905
5906
5907http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005908 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5910 yes | no | yes | yes
5911
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005912 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005913 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5914 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5915 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5916 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5917 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5918 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5919 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5920 and '-'.
5921
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005922 Examples :
5923 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005925
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005926http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5927 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5928 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5929 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5930 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 yes | yes | yes | yes
5933 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005934 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005935 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005936 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005937 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005938
5939 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5940 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5941 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5942 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5943
5944 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5945 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5946 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5947 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5948
5949 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5950 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5951 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5952 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5953 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5954 chroot is performed.
5955
5956 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5957 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5958 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5959 considered.
5960
5961 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5962 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5963 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5964 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5965 considered as a raw string.
5966
5967 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5968 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5969 "content-type".
5970
5971 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5972 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5973 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5974 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5975 evaluated as a log-format string.
5976
5977 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5978 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5979 argument to "content-type".
5980
5981 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5982 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5983 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5984 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5985
5986 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5987 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5988 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5989 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5990 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5991 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5992 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5993 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5994
5995 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5996 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5997 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5998
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005999 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6000 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6001 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6002 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6003 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6004
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006005 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6006 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6007
6008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006010 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6011
6012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 no | yes | yes | yes
6014
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006015 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6016 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6017 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6018 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6019 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6022 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026 Example:
6027 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6028 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6029 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006031 http-request allow if nagios
6032 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6033 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6034 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006036 Example:
6037 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6038 acl add path /addacl
6039 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006041 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6044 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006046 Example:
6047 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6048 acl setmap path /setmap
6049 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006052
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006053 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6054 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6057 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006059http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006061 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6062 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6063 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6064 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6065 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6066 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6067 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6068 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006070http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006072 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6073 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6074 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6075 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6076 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6077 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6078 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6079 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006081http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006083 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6084 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006085
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006087http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6090 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6091 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6092 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6093 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006094
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006095 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6096 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6097 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6098 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6099 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6100 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6101 instead.
6102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006103 Example:
6104 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6105 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006106
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006107http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006108
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006109 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006111http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6112 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6115 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6116 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6117 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6118 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6119 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6120 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6121 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6122 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6125 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6126 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006127 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6128
6129 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6130 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6131 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6132 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006134http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006136 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6137 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6138 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6139 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6140 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6141 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006142
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006143http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006144
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006145 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6146 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6147 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6148 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6149 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006151http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006153 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6154 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6155 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6156 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6157 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6158 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006159
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006160http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6161http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6162 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6163 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6164 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6165 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006166
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006167 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6168 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6169 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006170 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006171 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6172 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6173 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006174 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006175 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006176
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006177http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6178 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6179 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6180 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6181
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006182http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6183
6184 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6185 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6186 pointed by <resolvers>.
6187 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6188 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6189 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6190 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6191 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6192 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6193 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6194 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6195 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6196 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006197 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6198 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006199
6200 Example:
6201 resolvers mydns
6202 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6203 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6204 timeout retry 1s
6205 hold valid 10s
6206 hold nx 3s
6207 hold other 3s
6208 hold obsolete 0s
6209 accepted_payload_size 8192
6210
6211 frontend fe
6212 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006213 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006214 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6215
6216 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6217 # which mean DNS resolution error
6218 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6219
6220 default_backend be
6221
6222 backend b_503
6223 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6224 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6225 # 503 error page to end users
6226
6227 backend be
6228 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6229 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6230 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6231 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6232 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6233
6234 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6235 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6236
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006237http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6238
6239 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6240 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6241 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6242 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006243 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6244 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006245
6246 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6247
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006248http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006249http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006250http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006251http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006252http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006253http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006254http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006255http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6256http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006257
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006258 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6259
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006260 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006261 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6262 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6263 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6264 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006265
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006266 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6267 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6268 the supported backend.
6269
6270 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6271 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6272 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6273 number of segments in the path.
6274
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006275 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6276 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6277 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6278 when improperly combined.
6279
6280 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6281 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6282 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6283 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6284 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6285
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006286 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006287
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006288 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6289
6290 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6291 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6292
6293 Example:
6294 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6295
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006296 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6297
6298 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6299 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6300
6301 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6302 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6303
6304 Example:
6305 - /#foo -> /
6306
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006307 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6308 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006309
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006310 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6311 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6312
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006313 Example:
6314 - /. -> /
6315 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6316 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6317 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006318
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006319 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6320 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6321
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006322 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006323 their preceding segment.
6324
6325 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6326 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6327
6328 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6329 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006330
6331 Example:
6332 - /foo/../ -> /
6333 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6334 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6335 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006336 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006337 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006338 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006339
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006340 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6341 removed as well:
6342
6343 Example:
6344 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6345 - /bar/../../ -> /
6346
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006347 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6348 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006349
6350 Example:
6351 - // -> /
6352 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6353
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006354 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6355 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6356
6357 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6358 ".", "_", and "~".
6359
6360 Example:
6361 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6362 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6363 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6364 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6365
6366 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6367 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6368
6369 Example:
6370 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6371 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6372
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006373 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006374 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006375
6376 Example:
6377 - /%6f -> /%6F
6378 - /%zz -> /%zz
6379
6380 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6381 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6382
6383 Example:
6384 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6385
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006386 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006387 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6388 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6389
6390 Example:
6391 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6392 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6393 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006395http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006397 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6398 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6399 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6400 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6401 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006403http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006405 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6406 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6407 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6408 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006410http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6411 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006412
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006413 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006414 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6415 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6416 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6417 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6418 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006419
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006420 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6421 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6422 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6423 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6424 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006425
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006426 Example:
6427 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6428
6429 # applied to:
6430 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6431
6432 # outputs:
6433 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6434
6435 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006436
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006437 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6438
6439 # applied to:
6440 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006442 # outputs:
6443 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006444
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006445http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6447
6448 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6449 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006450 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6451 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6452 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006453
6454 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6455 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6456 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6457
6458 Example:
6459 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6460 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6461
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006462 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6463 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6464 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6465 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6466
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006467http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6468 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6469
6470 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6471 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6472 query-string are replaced.
6473
6474 Example:
6475 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6476 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6477
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006478http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6479 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6480
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006481 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6482 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6483 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6484 against.
6485
6486 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6487 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6488 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006489
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006490 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6491 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6492 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6493 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6494 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6495 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6496 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6497 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6498 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006499 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6500 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006501
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006502 Example:
6503 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6504 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006505
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006506 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6507 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006509http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6510 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006511
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006512 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6513 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6514 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6515 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006516
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006517 Example:
6518 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006519
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006520 # applied to:
6521 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006522
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006523 # outputs:
6524 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006525
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006526http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6527 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6528 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006529 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006530 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6531
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006532 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006533 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6534 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006535 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006536 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006537 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006538 are followed to create the response :
6539
6540 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6541 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6542 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6543 ignored.
6544
6545 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6546 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006547 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006548 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6549 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006550
6551 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6552 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6553 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006554 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006555 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006556
6557 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6558 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6559 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006560 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006561 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006562 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006563
6564 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6565 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6566 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6567 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6568 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6569 as a raw content.
6570
6571 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6572 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6573 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6574 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6575 considered as a raw string.
6576
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006577 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006578 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6579 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6580 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6581
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006582 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6583 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006584 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006585
6586 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6587
6588 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006589 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006590 if { path /ping }
6591
6592 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6593 if { path /favicon.ico }
6594
6595 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6596 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6597 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6600http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006602 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6603 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6604 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006605
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006606http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6607 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006608
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006609 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6610 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6611 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6612 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006616 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6617 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6618 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6619 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6620 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006622 Arguments:
6623 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6624 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 Example:
6627 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6628 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006630 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6631 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006633http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006635 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6636 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6637 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639 Arguments:
6640 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6641 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643 Example:
6644 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6645 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006647 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6648 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6649 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006651http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006653 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6654 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6655 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6656 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6657 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006659 Example:
6660 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6661 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6662 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6663 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6664 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6665 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6666 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6667 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6668 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006670http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006672 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6673 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6674 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6675 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6676 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006678http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6679 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006681 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6682 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6683 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6684 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6685 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6686 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6687 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6688 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6689 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006691http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006693 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6694 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6695 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6696 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6697 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6698 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6699 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006701http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006703 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6704 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6705 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006707http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006709 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6710 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6711 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6712 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6713 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6714 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6715 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6716 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006718http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6721 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6722 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6723 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6724 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6725 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006727 Example :
6728 # prepend the host name before the path
6729 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006730
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006731http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6732
6733 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6734 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6735 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006737http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006738
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006739 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6740 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6741 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6742 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6743 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006745http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006747 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6748 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6749 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6750 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6751 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6752 values have higher priority.
6753 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6754 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6755 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6756 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6757 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006759http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006761 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6762 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6763 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6764 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6765 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6766 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6767 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006769 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006770
6771 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006772 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6773 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006775http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6776 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6777 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6778 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006779 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6780 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006781
6782 Arguments :
6783 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6784 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006785
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006786 See also "option forwardfor".
6787
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006788 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006789 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6790 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6791
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006792 # After the masking this will track connections
6793 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6794 http-request track-sc0 src
6795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006796 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6797 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6798
6799http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6800
6801 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6802 expression.
6803
6804 Arguments:
6805 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6806 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006807
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006808 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006809 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6810 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6811
6812 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6813 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6814 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6815
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006816http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006817 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6818
6819 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6820 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6821 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6822 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6823 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6824
6825 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6826 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6827 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6828 results.
6829
6830 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006831 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6832 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006834http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6835
6836 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6837 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6838 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6839 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6840 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6841 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6842 information from the request.
6843
6844 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6845
6846http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6847
6848 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6849 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulete6794272022-11-22 15:41:48 +01006850 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
6851 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
6852 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
6853 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
6854 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006855 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6856
6857http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6858
6859 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6860 inline.
6861
6862 Arguments:
6863 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6864 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6865 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6866 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6867 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6868 (request and response)
6869 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6870 processing
6871 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6872 processing
6873 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6874 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6875 and '_'.
6876
6877 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6878 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006879
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006880 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006881 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006882
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006883http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6884 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006885
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006886 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6887 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6888 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6889 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6890 agent name must be used.
6891
6892 Arguments:
6893 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6894
6895 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6896 configuration.
6897
6898http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6899
6900 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6901 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6902 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6903 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6904 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6905 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6906 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6907 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6908 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6909 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6910 action.
6911 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6912 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6913 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6914 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6915 you fully understand how it works.
6916
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006917http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6918
6919 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6920 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6921 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6922 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6923 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006924 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006925 processing.
6926
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006927 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006928 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6929 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6930 rules evaluation.
6931
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006932http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6933http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6934 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6935 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6936 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6937 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006938
6939 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6940 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6941 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006942 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6943 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6944 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6945 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6946 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6947 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006948 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006949 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6950 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6951 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006952 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006953 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6954 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6955 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6956 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6957 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006958
6959http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6960http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6961http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6962
6963 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6964 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6965 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6966 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006967 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006968 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6969 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6970 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6971 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6972 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6973 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6974 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6975
6976 Arguments :
6977 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6978 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6979 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6980 select which table entry to update the counters.
6981
6982 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6983 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6984 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6985 that table until the session ends.
6986
6987 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6988 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6989 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6990 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6991 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6992 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6993 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6994 useful information.
6995
6996 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6997 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6998 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6999 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7000 checks that make use of it.
7001
7002http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7003
7004 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007005
7006 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007007 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007008
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007009http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7010
7011 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7012 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7013 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7014 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7015 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7016 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7017
7018 Arguments :
7019 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7020
7021 Example:
7022 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7023
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007024http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7025 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7026
7027 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7028 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7029 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7030 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7031 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7032 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7033 http-buffer-request".
7034
7035 Arguments :
7036
7037 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7038 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7039
7040 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007041 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007042 bytes.
7043
7044 Example:
7045 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7046
7047 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007049http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007051 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7052 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7053 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007054
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007056http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007057 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7058
7059 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7060 no | yes | yes | yes
7061
7062 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7063 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7064 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7065 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7066 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7067 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007069 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7070 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007072 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007073
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007074 Example:
7075 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007079 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7080 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007082 Example:
7083 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7088 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007090 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7091 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007093http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007095 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7096 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7097 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7098 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7099 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7100 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7101 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7102 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007104http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007105
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007106 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7107 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7108 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7109 example, or to pass some internal information.
7110 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7111 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7112 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007114http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007116 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7117 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007118
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007119http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007120
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007121 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007123http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007125 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7126 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7127 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7128 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7129 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7130 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7131 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007132
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007133 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7134 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7135 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7136 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7137 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007138
7139 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7140 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7141 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7142 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007144http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007146 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7147 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7148 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7149 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7150 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7151 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007152
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007153http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007154
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007155 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7156 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7157 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7158 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7159 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007161http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007163 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7164 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7165 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7166 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7167 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7168 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007169
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007170http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7171http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7172 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7173 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7174 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7175 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007176
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007177 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7178 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7179 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007180 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007181 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7182 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7183 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007184 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007185 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007187http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007189 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7190 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7191 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7192 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7193 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7194 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007196http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7197 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007198
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007199 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7200 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007202 Example:
7203 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007204
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007205 # applied to:
7206 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007208 # outputs:
7209 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007211 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007213http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7214 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007215
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007216 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007217 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007219 Example:
7220 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007222 # applied to:
7223 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007225 # outputs:
7226 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007227
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007228http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7229 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7230 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007231 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007232 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7233
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007234 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007235 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7236 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007237 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007238 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007239 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007240 are followed to create the response :
7241
7242 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7243 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7244 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7245 ignored.
7246
7247 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7248 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007249 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007250 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7251 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007252
7253 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7254 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7255 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007256 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007257 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007258
7259 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7260 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7261 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007262 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007263 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007264 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007265
7266 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7267 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7268 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7269 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7270 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7271 as a raw content.
7272
7273 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7274 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7275 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7276 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7277 considered as a raw string.
7278
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007279 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7280 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7281 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7282 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7283
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007284 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7285 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007286 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007287
7288 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7289
7290 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007291 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007292 if { status eq 404 }
7293
7294 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7295 string "This is the end !" \
7296 if { status eq 500 }
7297
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007298http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7299http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007300
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007301 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7302 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7303 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007304
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007305http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7306 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007307
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007308 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7309 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7310 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7311 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007312
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007313http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7314 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007316 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7317 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7318 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7319 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7320 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007322 Arguments:
7323 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007325 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7326 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007327
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007328http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007329
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007330 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7331 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7332 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007333
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007334http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7335
7336 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7337 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7338 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7339 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7340 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7341
7342http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7343
7344 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7345 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7346 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7347 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7348 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7349 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7350 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7351 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7352 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7353
7354http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7355
7356 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7357 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7358 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7359 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7360 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7361 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7362 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7363
7364http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7365
7366 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7367 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7368 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7369 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7370 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7371 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7372 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7373 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7374
7375http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7376 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7377
7378 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7379 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7380 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7381 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007382
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007383 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007384 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7385 http-response set-status 431
7386 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7387 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007388
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007389http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007391 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7392 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7393 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7394 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7395 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7396 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7397 based on some information from the request.
7398
7399 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7400
7401http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7402
7403 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7404 inline.
7405
7406 Arguments:
7407 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7408 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7409 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7410 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7411 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7412 (request and response)
7413 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7414 processing
7415 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7416 processing
7417 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7418 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7419 and '_'.
7420
7421 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7422 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007423
7424 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007425 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007427http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007429 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7430 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7431 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7432 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7433 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7434 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7435 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7436 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7437 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7438 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7439 action.
7440 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7441 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7442 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7443 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7444 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007445
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007446http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7447
7448 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7449 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7450 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7451 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7452 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007453 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007454 processing.
7455
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007456 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007457 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007458 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007459 rules evaluation.
7460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007461http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7462http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7463http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007464
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007465 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7466 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7467 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7468 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7469 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007470 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007471
7472http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7473
7474 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7475 about <var-name>.
7476
7477 Example:
7478 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7479
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007480http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7481 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7482
7483 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7484 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7485 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7486 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7487 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7488 buffer is full.
7489
7490 Arguments :
7491
7492 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7493 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7494
7495 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007496 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007497 bytes.
7498
7499 Example:
7500 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007501
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007502http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7503 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7504
7505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7506 yes | no | yes | yes
7507
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007508 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007509 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7510 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7511 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007512
7513 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7514
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007515 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7516 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7517 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7518 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7519 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7520 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7521 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007522 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007523 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7524 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007525
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007526 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7527 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7528 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7529 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7530 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7531 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7532 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007533 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7534 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7535 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7536 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7537 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7538 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007539
7540 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7541 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7542 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7543 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7544 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7545 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7546 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7547 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007548 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007549 downsides of rare connection failures.
7550
7551 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7552 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7553 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7554 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7555 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7556 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007557 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007558 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7559 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7560 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7561 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7562 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7563
7564 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007565 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7566 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7567 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7568 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007569
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007570 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7571 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007572
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007573 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007574
7575 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7576 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7577 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7578
Willy Tarreauee9afa22022-11-25 09:17:18 +01007579 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
7580 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
7581 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
7582 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
7583 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
7584 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
7585 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
7586 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
7587 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
7588 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
7589 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
7590
7591 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
7592 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
7593 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
7594 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
7595 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
7596
7597 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
7598 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007599
7600
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007601http-send-name-header [<header>]
7602 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007603 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7604 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007605 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007606 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7607
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007608 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7609 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7610 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7611 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7612 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7613 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7614 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7615 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7616 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7617 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7618 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7619 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7620 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7621 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7622 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7623 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007624
7625 See also : "server"
7626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007627id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007628 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7630 no | yes | yes | yes
7631 Arguments : none
7632
7633 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7634 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7635 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007636
7637
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007638ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7639 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7640 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007641 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007642
7643 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7644 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7645 and running).
7646
7647 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7648 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7649 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007650 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007651 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7652
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007653 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7654 "unless" condition is met.
7655
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007656 Example:
7657 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7658 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7659 ignore-persist if url_static
7660
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007661 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7662
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007663load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7664 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7666 yes | no | yes | yes
7667
7668 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7669 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7670 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007671 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007672 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007673 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7674 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7675 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7676
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007677 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007678 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007679 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007680
7681 Arguments:
7682 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7683 named "server-state-file".
7684
7685 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7686 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7687 name is used as a file name.
7688
7689 none don't load any stat for this backend
7690
7691 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007692 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7693 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7694 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007695 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007696 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007697
7698 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7699 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7700
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007701 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007702
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007703 global
7704 stats socket /tmp/socket
7705 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007706
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007707 defaults
7708 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007709
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007710 backend bk
7711 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7712 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007713
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007714
7715 Then one can run :
7716
7717 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7718
7719 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7720
7721 1
7722 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7723 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7724 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7725
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007726 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007727
7728 global
7729 stats socket /tmp/socket
7730 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7731
7732 defaults
7733 load-server-state-from-file local
7734
7735 backend bk
7736 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7737 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7738
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007739
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007740 Then one can run :
7741
7742 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7743
7744 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7745
7746 1
7747 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7748 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7749 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7750
7751 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7752 "show servers state"
7753
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007754
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007755log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007756log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007757 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007758no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007759 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7761 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007762
7763 Prefix :
7764 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7765 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7766 prefix does not allow arguments.
7767
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007768 Arguments :
7769 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7770 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7771 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7772 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7773 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7774 parameter.
7775
7776 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7777 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7778
7779 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7780 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7781 standard syslog port).
7782
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007783 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7784 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7785 standard syslog port).
7786
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007787 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7788 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7789 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007790 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007791
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007792 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7793 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7794 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7795 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7796 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7797 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7798 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7799 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7800 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7801 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7802 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7803 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007804 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007805 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7806 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7807 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007808 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7809 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007810
7811 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7812 and "fd@2", see above.
7813
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007814 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7815 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7816 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7817 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7818 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7819 having the logs instantly available.
7820
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007821 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7822 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7823 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7824
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007825 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7826 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007827
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007828 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7829 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7830 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7831 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7832 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7833 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7834 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7835 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7836 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7837 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007838 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007839
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007840 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7841 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7842 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7843 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7844 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7845
7846 <sample_size>
7847 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7848 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7849 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7850 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7851 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7852
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007853 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7854 one of the following :
7855
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007856 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7857 field is stripped. This is the default.
7858 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7859 rfc3164.
7860
7861 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007862 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7863
7864 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7865 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7866
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007867 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7868 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7869 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7870 designed to be used with a local log server.
7871
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007872 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7873 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7874 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7875 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7876 systemd logger consumes.
7877
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007878 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7879 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7880 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7881 used with a local log server.
7882
7883 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7884 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7885 designed to be used with a local log server.
7886
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007887 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7888 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7889 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7890 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7891
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007892 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7893
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007894 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7895 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7896 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007898 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7899 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7900 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7901 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007902
7903 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7904 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7905 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007906 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7907 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7908 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7909 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7910 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007911
7912 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7913
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007914 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7915 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7916 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007917
7918 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7919 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7920 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7921 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7922
7923 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7924 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007925
7926 Example :
7927 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007928 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7929 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7930 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007931 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007932 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7933 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007934 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007935
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007936
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007937log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007938 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7940 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007941
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007942 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7943 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7944 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7945 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7946 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007947
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007948 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7949 "option httplog" directives.
7950
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007951log-format-sd <string>
7952 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7954 yes | yes | yes | no
7955
7956 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7957 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7958 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7959 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7960 which covers the log format string in depth.
7961
7962 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7963 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7964
7965 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7966 log format to "rfc5424".
7967
7968 Example :
7969 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7970
7971
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007972log-tag <string>
7973 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7974 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7975 yes | yes | yes | yes
7976
7977 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7978 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007979 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007980 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7981 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7982 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7983 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7984 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7985 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007986
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007987max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7988 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7990 yes | no | yes | yes
7991
7992 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7993 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7994 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7995 servers.
7996
7997 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007998 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007999 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8000 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8001 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008002 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008003 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8004 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8005 picking a different server.
8006
8007 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8008 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8009 even if they have to be queued.
8010
8011 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8012 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8013
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008014max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8015 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8016 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8017 defined at build time).
Aurelien DARRAGON85f953c2023-11-20 17:53:36 +01008018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8019 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008020
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008021maxconn <conns>
8022 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8024 yes | yes | yes | no
8025 Arguments :
8026 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8027 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8028 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8029 closes.
8030
8031 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008032 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008033 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8034 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008035 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8036 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8037 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8038 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008039
8040 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8041 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8042 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8043
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008044 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8045 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008046
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008047 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8048
8049
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008050mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008051 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 yes | yes | yes | yes
8054 Arguments :
8055 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8056 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8057 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8058 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8059
8060 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8061 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8062 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8063 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8064 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8065
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008066 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8067 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8068 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008069
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008070 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008071 defaults http_instances
8072 mode http
8073
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008074
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008075monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008076 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8078 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008079 Arguments :
8080 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8081 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008082 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008083 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8084 backend and its backup.
8085
8086 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8087 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8088 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8089 servers in a list of backends.
8090
8091 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8092 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8093 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008094 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008095 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8096 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008097 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008098 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8099 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008100
8101 Example:
8102 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008103 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008104 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8105 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8106 monitor-uri /site_alive
8107 monitor fail if site_dead
8108
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008109 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008110
8111
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008112monitor-uri <uri>
8113 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8115 yes | yes | yes | no
8116 Arguments :
8117 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8118 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8119
8120 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8121 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8122 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8123 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8124 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8125 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8126 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8127 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8128
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008129 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008130 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8131 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau28848542022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008132 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8133 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8134 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008135 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8136 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8137 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008138
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008139 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8140 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8141 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8142 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8143
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008144 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008145 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008146 frontend www
8147 mode http
8148 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8149
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008150 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008151
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008152
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008153option abortonclose
8154no option abortonclose
8155 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8157 yes | no | yes | yes
8158 Arguments : none
8159
8160 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8161 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8162 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8163 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008164 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008165 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8166 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8167 encountered while delivering the response.
8168
8169 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8170 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8171 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8172 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8173 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8174 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008175 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008176 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008177 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008178 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8179 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8180 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8181
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008182 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8183 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008184 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8185 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8186 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8187 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8188 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8189 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008190 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008191
8192 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8193 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8194
8195 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8196
8197
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008198option accept-invalid-http-request
8199no option accept-invalid-http-request
8200 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8202 yes | yes | yes | no
8203 Arguments : none
8204
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008205 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008206 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008207 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008208 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8209 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8210 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8211 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8212 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008213 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8214 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8215 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8216 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008217 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008218 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008219 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8220 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +02008221 and the minor version. Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to
8222 contain fragment references ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008223
8224 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8225 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8226 been confirmed.
8227
8228 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8229 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008230 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8231 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008232 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8233
8234 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8235 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8236
8237 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8238 stats socket.
8239
8240
8241option accept-invalid-http-response
8242no option accept-invalid-http-response
8243 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8245 yes | no | yes | yes
8246 Arguments : none
8247
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008248 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008249 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008250 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008251 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8252 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8253 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8254 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8255 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008256 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8257 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8258 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008259
8260 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8261 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8262 been confirmed.
8263
8264 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8265 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8266 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8267 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8268
8269 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8270 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8271
8272 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8273 stats socket.
8274
8275
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008276option allbackups
8277no option allbackups
8278 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8280 yes | no | yes | yes
8281 Arguments : none
8282
8283 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8284 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8285 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8286 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8287 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8288 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8289 order between the backup servers anymore.
8290
8291 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8292 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8293
8294 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8295 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8296
8297
8298option checkcache
8299no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008300 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8302 yes | no | yes | yes
8303 Arguments : none
8304
8305 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8306 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008307 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008308 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8309 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008310 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008311
8312 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008313 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008314 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008315 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8316 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008317 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008318 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008319 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8320 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008321 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008322 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8323 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008324 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008325 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8326 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8327 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8328 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8329 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8330 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8331 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8332 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8333 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8334
8335 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008336 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8337 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8338 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8339 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008340
8341 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8342 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008343 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008344 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008345
8346 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8347 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8348
8349
8350option clitcpka
8351no option clitcpka
8352 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8354 yes | yes | yes | no
8355 Arguments : none
8356
8357 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8358 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008359 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008360 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8361
8362 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8363 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8364 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8365 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8366
8367 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8368 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8369 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8370 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8371 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8372
8373 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8374
8375 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8376 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8377 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8378
8379 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8380 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8381
8382 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8383
8384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008385option contstats
8386 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8388 yes | yes | yes | no
8389 Arguments : none
8390
8391 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8392 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8393 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008394 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008395 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8396 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8397 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8398 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8399 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008400
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008401option disable-h2-upgrade
8402no option disable-h2-upgrade
8403 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8404 connection.
8405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8406 yes | yes | yes | no
8407 Arguments : none
8408
8409 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8410 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8411 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8412 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008413 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8414 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8415 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8416 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8417 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8418 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008419
8420 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8421 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008422
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008423option dontlog-normal
8424no option dontlog-normal
8425 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8427 yes | yes | yes | no
8428 Arguments : none
8429
8430 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8431 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8432 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8433 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8434 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8435 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8436 logged.
8437
8438 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8439 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8440 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008442 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008443 logging.
8444
8445
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008446option dontlognull
8447no option dontlognull
8448 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8450 yes | yes | yes | no
8451 Arguments : none
8452
8453 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8454 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8455 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8456 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8457 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8458 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008459 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8460 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8461 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008462
8463 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008464 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008465 would not be logged.
8466
8467 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8468 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8469
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008470 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008471 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008472
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008473
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008474option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008475 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8477 yes | yes | yes | yes
8478 Arguments :
8479 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8480 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008481 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008482 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008483
8484 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8485 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8486 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8487 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8488 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8489 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8490 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008491 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8492 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8493 possible that the client has already brought one.
8494
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008495 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008496 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008497 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008498 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008499 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008500 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008501
8502 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8503 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8504 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8505 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8506 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8507 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008508 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008509
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008510 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8511 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008512 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008513 are under the control of the end-user.
8514
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008515 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008516 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8517 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008518 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8519 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8520 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008521
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008522 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008523 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8524 frontend www
8525 mode http
8526 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8527
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008528 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8529 backend www
8530 mode http
8531 option forwardfor header X-Client
8532
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008533 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008534 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008535
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008536
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008537option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8538no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8539 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8541 yes | yes | yes | no
8542 Arguments : none
8543
8544 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8545 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8546 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8547 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8548 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8549 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8550 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8551
8552 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8553 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8554 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8555 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8556 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8557 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8558 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8559 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8560 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8561 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8562
8563 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8564
8565 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8566 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8567
8568 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8569 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8570
8571
8572option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8573no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8574 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8576 yes | no | yes | yes
8577 Arguments : none
8578
8579 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8580 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8581 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8582 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8583 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8584 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8585 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8586
8587 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8588 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8589 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8590 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8591 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8592 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8593 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8594 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8595 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8596 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8597
8598 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8599
8600 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8601 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8602
8603 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8604 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8605
8606
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008607option http-buffer-request
8608no option http-buffer-request
8609 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8611 yes | yes | yes | yes
8612 Arguments : none
8613
8614 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8615 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8616 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8617 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8618 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8619 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008620 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8621 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8622 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8623 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008624
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008625 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8626 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008627
8628
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008629option http-ignore-probes
8630no option http-ignore-probes
8631 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8633 yes | yes | yes | no
8634 Arguments : none
8635
8636 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8637 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8638 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8639 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8640 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8641 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8642 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8643 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8644 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008645 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8646 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008647 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8648
8649 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8650 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8651 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8652 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8653 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8654 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8655 are often the only way to detect them.
8656
8657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8659
8660 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8661
8662
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008663option http-keep-alive
8664no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008665 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
8666 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8668 yes | yes | yes | yes
8669 Arguments : none
8670
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008671 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008672 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8673 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8674 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8675 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
8676 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008677
8678 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8679 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008680 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8681 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8682 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8683 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8684 situations where this option may be useful :
8685
8686 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008687 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008688
8689 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8690 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8691
8692 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008693
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008694 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8695 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8696 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8697 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8698 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8699 not set.
8700
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008701 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008702 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008703
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008704 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008705 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008706
8707
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008708option http-no-delay
8709no option http-no-delay
8710 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8712 yes | yes | yes | yes
8713 Arguments : none
8714
8715 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8716 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8717 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8718 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8719 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8720 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8721 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008722 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008723 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8724 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8725 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8726 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8727 affected.
8728
8729 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8730 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8731 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8732 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8733 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8734 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8735 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8736 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8737 latency environments.
8738
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008739 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8740
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008741
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008742option http-pretend-keepalive
8743no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008744 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
8745 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008747 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008748 Arguments : none
8749
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008750 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008751 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
8752 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
8753 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
8754 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
8755 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
8756 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008757
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008758 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008759 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008760 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008761 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008762 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008763 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8764
8765 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8766 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8767 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8768 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008769 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8770 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008771 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8772
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008773 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8774 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8775 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008776 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008777
8778 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8779 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8780
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008781 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008782 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008783
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008784option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8785 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8786 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8788 yes | yes | yes | yes
8789 Arguments :
8790 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8791 with no FastCGI application configured.
8792
8793 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8794 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8795 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8796
8797 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8798 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8799
8800 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8801 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8802 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8803 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8804 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8805 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8806 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8807 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8808
8809 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8810 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008811
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008812option http-server-close
8813no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008814 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8816 yes | yes | yes | yes
8817 Arguments : none
8818
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008819 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008820 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8821 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8822 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8823 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
8824 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
8825 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
8826 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
8827 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
8828 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
8829 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
8830 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
8831 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
8832 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008833
8834 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8835 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8836 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8837 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008838 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8839 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008840
8841 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8842 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008843 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8844 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8845 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008846
8847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8849
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008850 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
8851 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008852
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008853option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008854no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008855 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8857 yes | yes | yes | no
8858 Arguments : none
8859
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008860 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008861 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8862 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8863 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8864 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8865 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008866 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008867
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008868 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008869 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008870 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8871 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8872 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008873
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008874 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8875 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8876 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8877 front of an existing proxy.
8878
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008879 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8880
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008881 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008882
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008883option httpchk
8884option httpchk <uri>
8885option httpchk <method> <uri>
8886option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008887 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8889 yes | no | yes | yes
8890 Arguments :
8891 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8892 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8893 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8894 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8895 ones.
8896
8897 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8898 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8899 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8900
8901 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8902 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8903 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008904 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008905
8906 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8907 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8908 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8909 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8910 the lack of any response.
8911
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008912 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8913 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8914 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8915 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8916
8917 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8918 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8919 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008920
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008921 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8922 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008923 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008924 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008925 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008926
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008927 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8928 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8929 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8930 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8931
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008932 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008933 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8934 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8935 backend https_relay
8936 mode tcp
8937 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8938 http-check send hdr Host www
8939 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008940
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008941 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8942 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8943 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008944
8945
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008946option httpclose
8947no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008948 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8950 yes | yes | yes | yes
8951 Arguments : none
8952
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008953 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008954 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8955 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8956 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8957 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008958
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008959 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
8960 connection, depending where the option is set. Only the frontend is
8961 considered for client connections while the frontend and the backend are
8962 considered for server ones. In this case the option is enabled if at least
8963 one of the frontend or backend holding the connection has it enabled. If the
8964 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
8965 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
8966 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008967
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008968 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008969 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
8970 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008971
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008972 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008973 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008974
8975 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8976 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8977
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008978 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008979
8980
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008981option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008982 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008984 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008985 Arguments :
8986 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8987 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8988 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008989 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008990 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008991
8992 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8993 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8994 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8995 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8996 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8997 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8998 ports.
8999
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009000 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9001 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009002
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009003 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009005 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009006
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009007
9008option http_proxy
9009no option http_proxy
9010 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
9011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9012 yes | yes | yes | yes
9013 Arguments : none
9014
9015 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
9016 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
9017 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
9018 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
9019 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
9020
9021 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
9022 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009023 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
9024 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009025
9026 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9027 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9028
9029 Example :
9030 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
9031 backend direct_forward
9032 option httpclose
9033 option http_proxy
9034
9035 See also : "option httpclose"
9036
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009037
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009038option independent-streams
9039no option independent-streams
9040 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9042 yes | yes | yes | yes
9043 Arguments : none
9044
9045 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9046 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9047 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9048 receive data or not.
9049
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009050 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009051 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9052 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9053 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9054 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9055 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9056 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9057 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9058 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9059 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9060 socket buffers.
9061
9062 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9063 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9064 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9065 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9066 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9067
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009068 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009069
9070
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009071option ldap-check
9072 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9074 yes | no | yes | yes
9075 Arguments : none
9076
9077 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9078 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9079 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9080 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9081
9082 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9083 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9084
9085 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9086 configure it.
9087
9088 Example :
9089 option ldap-check
9090
9091 See also : "option httpchk"
9092
9093
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009094option external-check
9095 Use external processes for server health checks
9096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9097 yes | no | yes | yes
9098
9099 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9100 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9101 command".
9102
9103 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9104
9105 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9106
9107
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009108option idle-close-on-response
9109no option idle-close-on-response
9110 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9112 yes | yes | yes | no
9113 Arguments : none
9114
9115 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9116 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9117 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9118 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9119 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9120 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9121 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9122 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9123 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9124
9125 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9126 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9127
9128 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9129 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9130 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9131 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9132
9133 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9134 "hard-stop-after"
9135
9136
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009137option log-health-checks
9138no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009139 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9141 yes | no | yes | yes
9142 Arguments : none
9143
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009144 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9145 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9146 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009147
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009148 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9149 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9150 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9151 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9152 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9153
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009154 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009155 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009156
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009157 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9158 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9159 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009160
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009161
9162option log-separate-errors
9163no option log-separate-errors
9164 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9166 yes | yes | yes | no
9167 Arguments : none
9168
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009169 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009170 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9171 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9172 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9173 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9174 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9175 provides very important information.
9176
9177 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9178 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9179 error logs.
9180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009181 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009182 logging.
9183
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009184
9185option logasap
9186no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009187 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9189 yes | yes | yes | no
9190 Arguments : none
9191
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009192 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9193 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9194 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9195 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9196
9197 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9198 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9199 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9200 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9201 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009202 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009203 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9204 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9205 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9206 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009207 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009208
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009209 Examples :
9210 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9211 mode http
9212 option httplog
9213 option logasap
9214 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9215
9216 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9217 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9218 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9219 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009221 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009222 logging.
9223
9224
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009225option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009226 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9228 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009229 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009230 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9231 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009232 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9233 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009234
9235 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9236 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009237 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009238 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009239 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9240 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9241 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009242
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009243 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9244 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9245 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009246
9247 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009248 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009249 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9250 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9251 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9252 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9253 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9254 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9255 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9256
9257 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9258 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009259
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009260 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009261
9262 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9263 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9264 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9265 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009266 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009267 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009268
9269 See also: "option httpchk"
9270
9271
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009272option nolinger
9273no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009274 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009275 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9276 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009277 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009278
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009279 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009280 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9281 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9282 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9283 connections.
9284
9285 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9286 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009287 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9288 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9289 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9290 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9291 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9292 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9293 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9294 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9295 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9296 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9297 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9298 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9299 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009300
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009301 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9302 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9303 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9304 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9305 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009306
9307 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9308 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009309 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009310 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009311 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009312
9313 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9314 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9315
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009316 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9317 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009318
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009319option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9320 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9322 yes | yes | yes | yes
9323 Arguments :
9324 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9325 matching <network>
9326 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9327 header name.
9328
9329 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9330 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9331 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9332 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9333 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9334 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9335 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9336 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9337 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9338 possible that the client has already brought one.
9339
9340 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9341 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9342 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9343 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9344 header and requires different one.
9345
9346 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9347 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9348 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009349 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9350 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9351 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9352 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9353 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009354
9355 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9356 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9357 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9358 both are defined.
9359
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009360 Examples :
9361 # Original Destination address
9362 frontend www
9363 mode http
9364 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9365
9366 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9367 backend www
9368 mode http
9369 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9370
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009371 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009372
9373
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009374option persist
9375no option persist
9376 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9377 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9378 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009379 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009380
9381 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9382 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9383 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9384 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9385 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9386 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9387 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9388 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9389 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9390 redirected to another valid server.
9391
9392 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9393 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9394
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009395 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009396
9397
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009398option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009399 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9401 yes | no | yes | yes
9402 Arguments :
9403 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9404 PostgreSQL server.
9405
9406 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9407 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9408 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9409 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9410
9411 See also: "option httpchk"
9412
9413
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009414option prefer-last-server
9415no option prefer-last-server
9416 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9417 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9418 yes | no | yes | yes
9419 Arguments : none
9420
9421 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009422 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009423 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9424 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009425 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009426 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009427 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009428 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9429 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009430 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009431 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009432 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9433 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9434 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009435 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9436 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9437 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009438
9439 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9440 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9441
9442 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9443
9444
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009445option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009446option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009447no option redispatch
9448 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9449 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9450 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009451 Arguments :
9452 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9453 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9454 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009455 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009456 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009457 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009458 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9459 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9460 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9461
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009462
9463 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9464 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9465 be able to access the service anymore.
9466
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009467 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9468 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009469
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009470 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9471 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9472 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9473 following order:
9474
9475 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9476
9477 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9478 list, or
9479
9480 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9481
9482 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9483 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9484
9485 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9486 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9487 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9488 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9489
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009490 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009491 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9492 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009493
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009494 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9495 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9496
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009497 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009498
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009499
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009500option redis-check
9501 Use redis health checks for server testing
9502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9503 yes | no | yes | yes
9504 Arguments : none
9505
9506 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9507 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9508 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9509 find the "+PONG" response message.
9510
9511 Example :
9512 option redis-check
9513
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009514 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009515
9516
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009517option smtpchk
9518option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9519 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9521 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009522 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009523 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009524 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009525 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9526
9527 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9528 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9529 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9530
9531 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9532 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9533 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9534 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9535 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9536 dead server.
9537
9538 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9539 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009540 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009541 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9542
9543 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9544 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9545 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9546 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009547 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009548
9549 Example :
9550 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9551
9552 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009555option socket-stats
9556no option socket-stats
9557
9558 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9560 yes | yes | yes | no
9561
9562 Arguments : none
9563
9564
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009565option splice-auto
9566no option splice-auto
9567 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9569 yes | yes | yes | yes
9570 Arguments : none
9571
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009572 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009573 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009574 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009575 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009576 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009577 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9578 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9579 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9580 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9581
9582 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9583 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9584 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9585 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9586 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9587 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9588 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9589 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9590 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9591 keyword.
9592
9593 Example :
9594 option splice-auto
9595
9596 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9597 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9598
9599 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9600 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9601
9602
9603option splice-request
9604no option splice-request
9605 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9607 yes | yes | yes | yes
9608 Arguments : none
9609
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009610 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009611 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009612 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9613 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9614 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9615 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9616
9617 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9618
9619 Example :
9620 option splice-request
9621
9622 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9623 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9624
9625 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9626 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9627
9628
9629option splice-response
9630no option splice-response
9631 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9633 yes | yes | yes | yes
9634 Arguments : none
9635
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009636 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009637 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009638 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9639 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9640 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9641 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9642
9643 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9644
9645 Example :
9646 option splice-response
9647
9648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9650
9651 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9652 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9653
9654
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009655option spop-check
9656 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01009658 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009659 Arguments : none
9660
9661 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9662 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9663 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9664 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9665
9666 Example :
9667 option spop-check
9668
9669 See also : "option httpchk"
9670
9671
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009672option srvtcpka
9673no option srvtcpka
9674 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9676 yes | no | yes | yes
9677 Arguments : none
9678
9679 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9680 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009681 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009682 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9683
9684 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9685 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9686 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9687 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9688
9689 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9690 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9691 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9692 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9693 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9694
9695 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9696
9697 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9698 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9699 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9700
9701 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9702 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9703
9704 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9705
9706
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009707option ssl-hello-chk
9708 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9710 yes | no | yes | yes
9711 Arguments : none
9712
9713 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9714 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9715 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9716 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9717 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9718 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9719 hello message.
9720
9721 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9722 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9723 messages, which is appreciable.
9724
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009725 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009726 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9727 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009728
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009729 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9730
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009731
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009732option tcp-check
9733 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9734 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9735 yes | no | yes | yes
9736
9737 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9738 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9739
9740 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9741 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9742 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9743
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009744 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009745 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9746 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9747 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9748 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9749 only.
9750
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009751 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009752 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009753 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9754 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9755 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9756
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009757 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009758 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9759 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009760 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009761 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9762 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9763 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9764 the respective protocols.
9765 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009766 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009767
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009768 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009769
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009770 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9771 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9772 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9773 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009774
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009775 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9776 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9777 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009778
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009779
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009780 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009781 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009782 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009783 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009784
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009785 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009786 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009787 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009788
9789 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9790 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009791 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009792 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009793 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009794 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009795 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009796 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009797 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9798 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009799 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009800 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9801 tcp-check expect string +OK
9802
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009803 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009804 (send many headers before analyzing)
9805 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009806 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009807 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9808 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9809 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9810 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009811 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009812
9813
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009814 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009815
9816
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009817option tcp-smart-accept
9818no option tcp-smart-accept
9819 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9821 yes | yes | yes | no
9822 Arguments : none
9823
9824 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9825 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9826 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9827 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9828 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9829 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9830
9831 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9832 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9833 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9834 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9835
9836 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9837 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9838 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009839 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009840
9841 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9842 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9843 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9844
9845 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9846 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9847 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9848
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009849 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9850
9851
9852option tcp-smart-connect
9853no option tcp-smart-connect
9854 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9856 yes | no | yes | yes
9857 Arguments : none
9858
9859 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9860 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9861 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9862 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9863 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9864
9865 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9866 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9867 complex.
9868
9869 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9870 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9871 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9872
9873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9875
9876 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9877
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009878
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009879option tcpka
9880 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9882 yes | yes | yes | yes
9883 Arguments : none
9884
9885 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9886 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009887 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009888 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9889
9890 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9891 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9892 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9893 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9894
9895 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9896 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9897 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9898 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9899 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9900
9901 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9902
9903 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9904 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9905 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9906 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9907 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9908 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9909 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9910 backends.
9911
9912 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9913
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009914
9915option tcplog
9916 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009918 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009919 Arguments : none
9920
9921 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9922 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9923 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9924 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9925 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9926 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9927 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9928 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9929
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009930 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009932 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009933
9934
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009935option transparent
9936no option transparent
9937 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009939 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009940 Arguments : none
9941
9942 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9943 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9944 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9945 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9946 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9947 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9948 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9949 appropriate server.
9950
9951 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9952 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9953
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009954 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009955 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009956
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009957
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009958external-check command <command>
9959 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9961 yes | no | yes | yes
9962
9963 Arguments :
9964 <command> is the external command to run
9965
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009966 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9967
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009968 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009969
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009970 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9971 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9972 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9973 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9974 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9975 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009976
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009977 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9978
9979 Environment variables :
9980 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9981 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9982
9983 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9984
9985 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9986
9987 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9988 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9989 for a UNIX socket).
9990
9991 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9992
9993 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9994
9995 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9996
9997 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9998
9999 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10000
10001 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10002 socket).
10003
10004 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10005 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10006
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010007 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10008
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010009 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10010 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10011 failed.
10012
10013 Example :
10014 external-check command /bin/true
10015
10016 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10017
10018
10019external-check path <path>
10020 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10022 yes | no | yes | yes
10023
10024 Arguments :
10025 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10026
10027 The default path is "".
10028
10029 Example :
10030 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10031
10032 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10033 "external-check command"
10034
10035
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010036persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010037persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010038 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10040 yes | no | yes | yes
10041 Arguments :
10042 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010043 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10044 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010045
10046 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10047 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010048 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010049 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10050 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10051 forwarded to this server.
10052
10053 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10054 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10055 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010056 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010057 a single "listen" section.
10058
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010059 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10060 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10061 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10062
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010063 Example :
10064 listen tse-farm
10065 bind :3389
10066 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10067 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10068 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10069 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10070 persist rdp-cookie
10071 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010072 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010073 balance rdp-cookie
10074 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10075 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10076
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010077 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010078
10079
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010080rate-limit sessions <rate>
10081 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10083 yes | yes | yes | no
10084 Arguments :
10085 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10086 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10087
10088 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10089 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10090 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010091 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010092 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10093 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10094
10095 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10096 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10097 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10098 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10099
10100 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10101 listen smtp
10102 mode tcp
10103 bind :25
10104 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010105 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010106
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010107 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10108 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10109 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010110
10111 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10112
10113
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010114redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10115redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10116redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010117 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10119 no | yes | yes | yes
10120
10121 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010122 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010123
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010124 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010125 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010126 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10127 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10128 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010129
10130 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10131 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10132 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10133 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10134 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010135 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10136 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10137 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10138 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010139
10140 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10141 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10142 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10143 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10144 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10145 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010146 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010147 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010148 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10149 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10150 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010151
10152 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010153 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10154 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10155 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010156 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010157 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10158 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10159 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10160 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010161
10162 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010163 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010164
10165 - "drop-query"
10166 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10167 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10168 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10169 with a location-type redirect.
10170
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010171 - "append-slash"
10172 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10173 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10174 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10175 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10176
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010177 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10178 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10179 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10180 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10181 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10182 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10183 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10184
10185 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10186 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10187 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10188 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10189 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10190 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10191 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010192
10193 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10194 acl clear dst_port 80
10195 acl secure dst_port 8080
10196 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010197 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010198 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010199 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10200
10201 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010202 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10203 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10204 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010205 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010206
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010207 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10208 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10209 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10210
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010211 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010212 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010213
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010214 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010215 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10216 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10217 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010219 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010220
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010221
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010222retries <value>
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010223 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010224 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10225 yes | no | yes | yes
10226 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010227 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10228 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010229
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010230 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10231 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10232 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10233 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10234 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010235
10236 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010237 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010238 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010239
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010240 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10241 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10242 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010243
10244 See also : "option redispatch"
10245
10246
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010247retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010248 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10249 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10250 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10252 yes | no | yes | yes
10253 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010254 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10255 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10256 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10257 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10258 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010259
10260 none never retry
10261
10262 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10263 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10264
10265 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10266 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10267 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10268 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10269 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10270 processing the request.
10271
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010272 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10273 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10274 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10275 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10276 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10277 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10278 overflow attack for example).
10279
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010280 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10281 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10282 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10283 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10284 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10285 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10286 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10287 amplify denial of service attacks.
10288
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010289 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10290 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10291 considered to be safe to retry.
10292
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010293 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10294 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10295 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10296 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10297 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010298
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010299 all-retryable-errors
10300 retry request for any error that are considered
10301 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10302 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10303 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10304
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010305 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10306 not cumulative.
10307
10308 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10309 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10310 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10311 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10312
10313 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10314 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10315 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10316 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10317 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10318 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10319 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10320 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10321 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10322 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10323 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10324 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10325
10326 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10327 should not use this directive.
10328
10329 The default is "conn-failure".
10330
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010331 Example:
10332 retry-on 503 504
10333
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010334 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10335
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010336server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010337 Declare a server in a backend
10338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10339 no | no | yes | yes
10340 Arguments :
10341 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010342 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010343 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010344
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010345 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10346 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10347 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10348 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010349 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10350 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010351 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010352 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10353 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010354 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10355 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10356 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10357 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10358 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10359 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10360 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010361 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010362 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10363 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10364 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10365 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10366 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10367 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010368 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10369 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010370 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10371 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010372
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010373 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010374 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10375 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10376 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10377 adding this value to the client's port.
10378
10379 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10380 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010381 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010382
10383 Examples :
10384 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10385 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010386 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010387 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10388 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10389 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010390
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010391 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10392 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10393 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10394 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10395 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10396
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010397 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10398 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010399
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010400server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010401 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010402 this backend.
10403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10404 no | no | yes | yes
10405
10406 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10407 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10408 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10409 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10410 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010411
10412 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10413 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10414
10415 global
10416 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10417
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010418 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010419 load-server-state-from-file
10420
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010421 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010422 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010423
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010424server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10425 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10426 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10428 no | no | yes | yes
10429
10430 Arguments:
10431 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10432
10433 <num | range>
10434 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10435 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10436 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10437 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10438
10439 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10440
10441 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10442
10443 <params*>
10444 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10445 keyword.
10446
10447 Examples:
10448 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10449 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10450 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10451
10452 # or
10453 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10454
10455 # would be equivalent to:
10456 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10457 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10458 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10459
10460
10461
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010462source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010463source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010464source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010465 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10467 yes | no | yes | yes
10468 Arguments :
10469 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10470 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010471
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010472 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010473 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10474 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10475 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10476 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10477 supported prefixes are :
10478 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10479 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10480 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010481 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010482 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10483 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010484
10485 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10486 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010487 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10488 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10489 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010490
10491 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10492 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10493 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10494 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10495 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10496 <addr>.
10497
10498 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10499 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10500 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10501 port.
10502
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010503 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10504 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10505 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10506 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010507 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010508 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10509 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10510 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10511 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10512 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10513 HTTP header.
10514
10515 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10516 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010517 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010518 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10519 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10520 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10521 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10522 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10523 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10524 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10525
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010526 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10527 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10528 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10529 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10530 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10531 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10532
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010533 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10534 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10535 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10536 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10537
10538 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10539 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10540 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10541 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10542 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10543 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10544
10545 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10546 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10547 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10548 there are two methods :
10549
10550 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10551 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10552 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10553 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10554 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10555 of the client ranges may be used.
10556
10557 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10558 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10559 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10560 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10561 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10562 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10563 same session.
10564
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010565 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10566 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10567 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010568 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010569
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010570 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10571
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010572 Examples :
10573 backend private
10574 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10575 source 192.168.1.200
10576
10577 backend transparent_ssl1
10578 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10579 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10580
10581 backend transparent_ssl2
10582 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10583 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10584 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10585
10586 backend transparent_ssl3
10587 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10588 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10589 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10590
10591 backend transparent_smtp
10592 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10593 # with Tproxy version 4.
10594 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10595
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010596 backend transparent_http
10597 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10598 # proxy.
10599 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010601 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010602 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10603
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010604
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010605srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10606 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10607 the connection on the server side.
10608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10609 yes | no | yes | yes
10610 Arguments :
10611 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10612
10613 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10614 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010615 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10616 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010617
10618 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10619
10620
10621srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10622 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10623 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10624 server side.
10625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10626 yes | no | yes | yes
10627 Arguments :
10628 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10629 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10630 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10631 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10632
10633 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10634 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010635 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10636 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010637
10638 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10639
10640
10641srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10642 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10644 yes | no | yes | yes
10645 Arguments :
10646 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10647 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10648 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10649 document.
10650
10651 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10652 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010653 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10654 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010655
10656 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10657
10658
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010659stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10660 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010662 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010663
10664 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10665 matched.
10666
10667 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10668 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10669
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010670 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10671 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010672 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010673
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010674 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10675 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10676 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10677 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010678
10679 Example :
10680 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10681 backend stats_localhost
10682 stats enable
10683 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10684
10685 Example :
10686 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10687 backend stats_auth
10688 stats enable
10689 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10690 stats admin if TRUE
10691
10692 Example :
10693 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10694 userlist stats-auth
10695 group admin users admin
10696 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10697 group readonly users haproxy
10698 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10699
10700 backend stats_auth
10701 stats enable
10702 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10703 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10704 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10705 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10706
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010707 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10708 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10709 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010710
10711
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010712stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10713 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010715 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010716 Arguments :
10717 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10718
10719 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10720
10721 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10722 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10723 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10724 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10725 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10726 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10727
10728 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10729 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10730 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010731 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010732
10733 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10734 report using "stats scope".
10735
10736 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10737 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10738 unobvious parameters.
10739
10740 Example :
10741 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10742 backend public_www
10743 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10744 stats enable
10745 stats hide-version
10746 stats scope .
10747 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010748 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010749 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10750 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10751
10752 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10753 backend private_monitoring
10754 stats enable
10755 stats uri /admin?stats
10756 stats refresh 5s
10757
10758 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10759
10760
10761stats enable
10762 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010764 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010765 Arguments : none
10766
10767 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10768 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10769 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10770 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10771 - stats auth : no authentication
10772 - stats scope : no restriction
10773
10774 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10775 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10776 unobvious parameters.
10777
10778 Example :
10779 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10780 backend public_www
10781 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10782 stats enable
10783 stats hide-version
10784 stats scope .
10785 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010786 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010787 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10788 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10789
10790 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10791 backend private_monitoring
10792 stats enable
10793 stats uri /admin?stats
10794 stats refresh 5s
10795
10796 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10797
10798
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010799stats hide-version
10800 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010802 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010803 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010804
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010805 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10806 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10807 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10808 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10809 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10810 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010812 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10813 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10814 unobvious parameters.
10815
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010816 Example :
10817 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10818 backend public_www
10819 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010820 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010821 stats hide-version
10822 stats scope .
10823 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010824 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010825 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10826 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010827
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010828 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10829 backend private_monitoring
10830 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010831 stats uri /admin?stats
10832 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010833
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010834 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010835
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010836
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010837stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10838 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10839 Access control for statistics
10840
10841 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10842 no | no | yes | yes
10843
10844 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10845 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10846 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10847 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10848 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10849 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10850
10851 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10852 instance.
10853
10854 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10855 about ACL usage.
10856
10857
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010858stats realm <realm>
10859 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010861 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010862 Arguments :
10863 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10864 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10865 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10866
10867 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10868 using a backslash ('\').
10869
10870 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10871 only related to authentication.
10872
10873 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10874 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10875 unobvious parameters.
10876
10877 Example :
10878 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10879 backend public_www
10880 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10881 stats enable
10882 stats hide-version
10883 stats scope .
10884 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010885 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010886 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10887 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10888
10889 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10890 backend private_monitoring
10891 stats enable
10892 stats uri /admin?stats
10893 stats refresh 5s
10894
10895 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10896
10897
10898stats refresh <delay>
10899 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010901 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010902 Arguments :
10903 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10904 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10905 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10906 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10907 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10908 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10909
10910 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10911 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10912 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010913 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010914
10915 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10916 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10917 unobvious parameters.
10918
10919 Example :
10920 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10921 backend public_www
10922 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10923 stats enable
10924 stats hide-version
10925 stats scope .
10926 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010927 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010928 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10929 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10930
10931 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10932 backend private_monitoring
10933 stats enable
10934 stats uri /admin?stats
10935 stats refresh 5s
10936
10937 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10938
10939
10940stats scope { <name> | "." }
10941 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010943 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010944 Arguments :
10945 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10946 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10947 section in which the statement appears.
10948
10949 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10950 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10951 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10952 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10953 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10954 exists.
10955
10956 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10957 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10958 unobvious parameters.
10959
10960 Example :
10961 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10962 backend public_www
10963 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10964 stats enable
10965 stats hide-version
10966 stats scope .
10967 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010968 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010969 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10970 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10971
10972 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10973 backend private_monitoring
10974 stats enable
10975 stats uri /admin?stats
10976 stats refresh 5s
10977
10978 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10979
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010980
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010981stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010982 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010984 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010985
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010986 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010987 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10988
10989 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10990 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10991
10992 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10993 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010994 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010995
10996 Example :
10997 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10998 backend private_monitoring
10999 stats enable
11000 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11001 stats uri /admin?stats
11002 stats refresh 5s
11003
11004 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11005 global section.
11006
11007
11008stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011009 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11011 yes | yes | yes | yes
11012 Arguments : none
11013
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011014 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011015 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11016 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11017 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11018 - IP (socket, server)
11019 - cookie (backend, server)
11020
11021 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11022 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011023 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011024
11025 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11026
11027
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011028stats show-modules
11029 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11031 yes | yes | yes | yes
11032 Arguments : none
11033
11034 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11035 values as a tooltip.
11036
11037 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11038 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11039 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11040
11041 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11042
11043
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011044stats show-node [ <name> ]
11045 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011047 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011048 Arguments:
11049 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11050 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11051
11052 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11053 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011054 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011055
11056 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11057 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11058 unobvious parameters.
11059
11060 Example:
11061 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11062 backend private_monitoring
11063 stats enable
11064 stats show-node Europe-1
11065 stats uri /admin?stats
11066 stats refresh 5s
11067
11068 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11069 section.
11070
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011071
11072stats uri <prefix>
11073 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011075 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011076 Arguments :
11077 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11078 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11079 query string.
11080
11081 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11082 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11083 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11084 possible to reach it in the application.
11085
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011086 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011087 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011088 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11089 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11090 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11091 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11092
11093 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11094 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11095 an address or a port to statistics only.
11096
11097 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11098 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11099 unobvious parameters.
11100
11101 Example :
11102 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11103 backend public_www
11104 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11105 stats enable
11106 stats hide-version
11107 stats scope .
11108 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011109 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011110 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11111 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11112
11113 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11114 backend private_monitoring
11115 stats enable
11116 stats uri /admin?stats
11117 stats refresh 5s
11118
11119 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11120
11121
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011122stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11123 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011125 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011126
11127 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011128 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011129 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011130 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011131 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11132
11133 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11134 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11135 the "stick-table" statement.
11136
11137 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11138 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11139 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11140 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11141 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11142
11143 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11144 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11145 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11146 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11147 transformation rules.
11148
11149 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11150 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11151 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11152 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11153 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11154 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11155 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11156
11157 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11158 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11159 ACL based conditions.
11160
11161 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11162 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11163 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11164 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11165
11166 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11167 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11168 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11169 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11170
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011171 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11172 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011173 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011174
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011175 Example :
11176 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11177 # last 30 minutes
11178 backend pop
11179 mode tcp
11180 balance roundrobin
11181 stick store-request src
11182 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11183 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11184 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11185
11186 backend smtp
11187 mode tcp
11188 balance roundrobin
11189 stick match src table pop
11190 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11191 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11192
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011193 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011194 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011195
11196
11197stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11198 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11200 no | no | yes | yes
11201
11202 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11203 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11204 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11205 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11206
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011207 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11208 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011209 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011210
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011211 Examples :
11212 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011213 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011214
11215 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11216 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11217 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11218
11219
11220 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11221 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11222 backend http
11223 mode http
11224 balance roundrobin
11225 stick on src table https
11226 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11227 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11228 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11229
11230 backend https
11231 mode tcp
11232 balance roundrobin
11233 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11234 stick on src
11235 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11236 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11237
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011238 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011239
11240
11241stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11242 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11244 no | no | yes | yes
11245
11246 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011247 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011248 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011249 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011250 server is selected.
11251
11252 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11253 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11254 the "stick-table" statement.
11255
11256 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11257 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11258 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11259 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11260 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11261 address.
11262
11263 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11264 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11265 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11266 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11267 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11268 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11269 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11270 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11271 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11272 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11273
11274 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11275 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11276 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11277 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11278 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11279 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11280 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11281
11282 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11283 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11284 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11285 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11286
11287 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11288 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11289 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11290 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11291 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11292 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011293 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11294 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11295 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11296 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11297 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11298 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011299
11300 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11301 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11302 the request.
11303
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011304 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11305 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011306 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011307
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011308 Example :
11309 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11310 # last 30 minutes
11311 backend pop
11312 mode tcp
11313 balance roundrobin
11314 stick store-request src
11315 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11316 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11317 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11318
11319 backend smtp
11320 mode tcp
11321 balance roundrobin
11322 stick match src table pop
11323 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11324 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11325
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011326 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011327 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011328
11329
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011330stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011331 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011332 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011333 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011335 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011336
11337 Arguments :
11338 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11339 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11340 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11341 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11342
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011343 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11344 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11345 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11346 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11347
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011348 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11349 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11350 instance.
11351
11352 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11353 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11354 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11355 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11356 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11357 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011358 to 32 characters.
11359
11360 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11361 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11362 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011363 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011364 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11365 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011366
11367 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011368 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11369 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011370 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11371 increase.
11372
11373 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011374 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11375 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11376 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011377
11378 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011379 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011380 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11381 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011382 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011383 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11384 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11385 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11386 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11387 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11388 parameter (see below).
11389
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011390 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11391 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11392 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11393 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11394 soft restart.
11395
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011396 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11397 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011398
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011399 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011400 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11401 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011402 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11403 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011404 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011405 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011406 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11407 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011408 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11409 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011410
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011411 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11412 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11413 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11414 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11415 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11416 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11417 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11418 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11419 token.
11420
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011421 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11422 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11423 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11424 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011425 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11426 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11427 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11428 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11429 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11430 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11431 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11432 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11433 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11434 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11435 types and their arguments.
11436
11437 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11438 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11439 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11440 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11441
11442 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11443 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11444 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011445 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011446
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011447 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11448 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11449 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011450 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011451 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011452 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011453
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011454 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11455 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11456 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11457 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11458
11459 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11460 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11461 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11462 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11463 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11464 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11465
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011466 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11467 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11468 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11469 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11470
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011471 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11472 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11473 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11474 they were received.
11475
11476 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11477 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11478 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11479 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11480 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11481
11482 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11483 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11484 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11485 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11486 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11487
11488 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11489 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11490 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11491
11492 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11493 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11494 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11495 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11496 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11497
11498 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11499 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11500 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11501 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11502 the client side.
11503
11504 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11505 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11506 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11507 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11508 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11509 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11510 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11511
11512 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11513 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11514 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11515 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11516 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11517 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011518 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011519
11520 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11521 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11522 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11523 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11524 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11525 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11526
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011527 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11528 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11529 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11530 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11531 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11532
11533 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11534 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11535 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11536 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11537 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11538 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11539
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011540 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011541 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011542 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11543 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11544
11545 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11546 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11547 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11548 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11549 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11550 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11551 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11552 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11553 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11554 recommended for better fairness.
11555
11556 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011557 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011558 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11559 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11560
11561 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11562 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11563 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11564 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11565 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11566 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11567 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11568 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11569 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11570 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011571
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011572 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11573 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011574 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11575 reference it.
11576
11577 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11578 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011579 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11580 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11581 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011582
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011583 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11584 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11585 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11586 something that can be ignored.
11587
11588 Example:
11589 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11590 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11591 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11592 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11593
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011594 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011595 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011596
11597
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011598stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011599 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11601 no | no | yes | yes
11602
11603 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011604 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011605 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011606 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011607 server is selected.
11608
11609 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11610 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11611 the "stick-table" statement.
11612
11613 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11614 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11615 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11616 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11617
11618 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11619 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11620 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11621 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11622 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11623 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011624 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011625 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11626 rules.
11627
11628 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11629 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11630 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11631 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11632 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11633 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11634 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11635
11636 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11637 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11638 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11639 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11640
11641 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11642 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11643 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11644 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11645 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11646 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011647 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11648 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11649 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11650 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11651 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11652 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11653 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11654 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11655 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011656
11657 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11658
11659 Example :
11660 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11661 backend https
11662 mode tcp
11663 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011664 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011665 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011666
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011667 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11668 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011669
11670 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11671 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11672 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11673
11674 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11675 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011676
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011677 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11678 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11679 # at offset 44.
11680
11681 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011682 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011683
11684 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011685 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011686
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011687 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11688 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11689
11690 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11691 extraction.
11692
11693
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011694tcp-check comment <string>
11695 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11696 it fails.
11697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11698 yes | no | yes | yes
11699
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011700 Arguments :
11701 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11702 rule fails.
11703
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011704 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11705 user-friendly error reporting.
11706
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011707 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11708 "tcp-check expect".
11709
11710
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011711tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11712 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011713 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011714 Opens a new connection
11715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011716 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011717
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011718 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011719 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11720
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011721 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011722 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011723
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011724 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011725 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11726 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011727 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011728
11729 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011730
11731 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11732
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011733 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11734
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011735 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11736
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011737 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11738
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011739 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11740 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11741 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11742 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11743
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011744 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11745 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11746 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11747 haproxy -vv.
11748
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011749 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011750
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011751 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11752 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11753 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11754
11755 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11756 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11757 of the sequence.
11758
11759 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11760 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11761 do.
11762
11763 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11764 unset-var or comment rules.
11765
11766 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011767 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11768 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11769 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11770 option tcp-check
11771 tcp-check connect
11772 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11773 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11774 tcp-check send \r\n
11775 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11776 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11777 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11778 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11779 tcp-check send \r\n
11780 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11781 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11782
11783 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11784 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011785 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011786 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11787 tcp-check connect port 143
11788 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11789 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11790
11791 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11792
11793
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011794tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011795 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011796 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011797 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011798 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011799 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011800 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011801
11802 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011803 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11804
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011805 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11806 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11807 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11808 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11809 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11810 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11811 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11812 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11813 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11814 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11815
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011816 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011817 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11818 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011819 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11820 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11821 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11822
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011823 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11824 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11825 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011826 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11827 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011828 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11829 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011830 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11831 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011832 By default "L7OK" is used.
11833
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011834 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11835 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011836 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11837 supported :
11838 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11839 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011840 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11841 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11842 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11843 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11844 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011845
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011846 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011847 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011848 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11849 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11850 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11851 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011852 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11853
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011854 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11855 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11856 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11857 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11858
11859 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11860 informational message reported in logs if an error
11861 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11862 log-format string.
11863
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011864 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11865 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11866 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11867 followed by some converters.
11868
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011869 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11870 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11871 with the usual backslash ('\').
11872 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011873 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011874 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11875 used upper or lower case.
11876
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011877 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11878
11879 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11880 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11881 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11882 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11883 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11884 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11885 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11886 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11887
11888 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11889 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11890 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11891 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11892 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11893 expression.
11894
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011895 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11896 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11897 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11898 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11899 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11900 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11901
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011902 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11903 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11904 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11905 this exact hexadecimal string.
11906 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11907
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011908 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11909 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11910 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11911 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11912 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11913 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11914 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11915 size.
11916
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011917 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11918 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11919 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11920 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11921 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11922 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11923 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11924 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11925 in a binary string before matching the response's
11926 buffer.
11927
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011928 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011929 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011930 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11931 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11932 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11933 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11934 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11935 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11936 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11937 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11938 the null character.
11939
11940 Examples :
11941 # perform a POP check
11942 option tcp-check
11943 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11944
11945 # perform an IMAP check
11946 option tcp-check
11947 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11948
11949 # look for the redis master server
11950 option tcp-check
11951 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011952 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011953 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11954 tcp-check expect string role:master
11955 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11956 tcp-check expect string +OK
11957
11958
11959 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011960 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011961
11962
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011963tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11964tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11965 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11966 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011968 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011969
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011970 Arguments :
11971 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11972
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011973 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11974 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011975
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011976 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11977 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011978
11979 Examples :
11980 # look for the redis master server
11981 option tcp-check
11982 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11983 tcp-check expect string role:master
11984
11985 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011986 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011987
11988
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011989tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11990tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11991 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11992 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011994 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011995
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011996 Arguments :
11997 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011998
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011999 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12000 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012001
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012002 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12003 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12004 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012005
12006 Examples :
12007 # redis check in binary
12008 option tcp-check
12009 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12010 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12011
12012
12013 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012014 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012015
12016
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012017tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012018 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012019 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012020 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012021
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012022 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012023 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12024 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12025 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12026 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12027 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12028 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12029 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12030 and '-'.
12031
12032 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12033
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012034 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012035 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
12036
12037
12038tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012039 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012040 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012041 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012042
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012043 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012044 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12045 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12046 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12047 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12048 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12049 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12050 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12051 and '-'.
12052
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012053 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012054 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12055
12056
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012057tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12058 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12060 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012061 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012062 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12063 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012065 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012066
12067 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12068 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012069 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12070 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12071 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12072 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12073 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12074 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012076 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12077 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12078 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12079 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012080
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012081 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012082 - accept :
12083 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12084 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12085 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012086
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012087 - reject :
12088 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12089 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12090 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12091 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12092 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12093 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12094 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12095 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12096 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12097 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12098 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012099 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012100
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012101 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12102 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12103 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12104 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12105 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12106 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12107 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12108 hosts.
12109
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012110 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12111 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12112 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12113 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12114 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12115 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12116 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12117 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12118
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012119 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12120 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12121 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12122 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12123 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12124 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12125 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12126 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12127 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012128 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12129 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012130
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012131 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012132 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012133 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12134 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12135 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012136 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012137 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012138 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12139 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12140 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12141 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12142 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12143 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12144 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012146 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012147 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012148 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012149 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012150 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12151 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12152 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012153
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012154 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12155 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12156 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12157 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012158
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012159 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12160 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12161 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12162 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12163 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012164 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12165 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12166 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12167 layer7 information is extracted.
12168
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012169 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12170 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12171 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12172 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12173 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012174
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012175 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12176 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12177 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12178 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12179
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012180 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12181 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12182 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12183 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12184
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012185 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12186 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12187 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12188 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12189 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012190
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012191 - set-src <expr> :
12192 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12193 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12194 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012195 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012197 Arguments:
12198 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12199 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012200
12201 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012202 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12203
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012204 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12205 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012206
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012207 - set-src-port <expr> :
12208 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12209 expression.
12210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012211 Arguments:
12212 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12213 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012214
12215 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012216 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12217
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012218 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12219 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12220 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012221
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012222 - set-dst <expr> :
12223 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12224 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12225 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12226 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12227 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12228
12229 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12230 followed by some converters.
12231
12232 Example:
12233
12234 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12235 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12236
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012237 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12238 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12239
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012240 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12241 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12242 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12243 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12244
12245
12246 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12247 followed by some converters.
12248
12249 Example:
12250
12251 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12252
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012253 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12254 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12255 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12256
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012257 - "silent-drop" :
12258 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012259 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012260 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12261 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12262 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12263 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12264 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012265 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12266 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012267 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12268 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012269 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012270 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12271 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12272 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12273 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012275 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12276 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12277 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012279 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12280 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12281 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012283 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012284 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012285 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012287 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12288 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12289 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012290
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012291 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012292 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12293 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012294
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012295 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12296
12297 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12298
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012299 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12300
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012301 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012302
12303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012304tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12305 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012307 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012308 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012309 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12310 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012311
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012312 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012313
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012314 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012315 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12316 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012317 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12318 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012319
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012320 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12321 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12322 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12323 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012324 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012325 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012326 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12327 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12328 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12329 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012330 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012331 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012332
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012333 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12334 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12335 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12336 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012337
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012338 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012339 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012340 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012341 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12342 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012343 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012344 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012345 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012346 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012347 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012348 - set-dst <expr>
12349 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012350 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012351 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012352 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012353 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012354 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012355 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012356
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012357 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12358 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012359 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12360 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012361
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012362 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12363 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12364 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12365 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12366 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12367 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012369 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012370 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12371 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012372
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012373 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12374 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12375 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12376 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12377 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12378 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12379
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012380 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012381 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12382 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12383 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12384 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12385 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12386 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12387 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12388 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12389 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12390 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012391
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012392 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012393 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12394 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12395 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012396
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012397 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12398 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12399
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012400 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012401 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12402 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012403
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012404 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12405 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012406 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012407 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12408 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012409 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012410 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012411 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012412 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12413 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012414 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012415 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12416 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012417
12418 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12419 followed by some converters.
12420
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012421 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012422 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12423 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12424 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12425 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12426 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12427 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012428 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012429 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12430 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12431
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012432 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12433
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012434 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12435 <var-name>.
12436
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012437 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12438 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12439 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12440 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12441 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12442
12443 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12444 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12445 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12446 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12447 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12448 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12449 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12450 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12451 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12452 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12453 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12454
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012455 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12456 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12457 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12458 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12459 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12460
12461 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12462
12463 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12464
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012465 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12466 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12467 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12468 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12469 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12470 evaluated.
12471
12472 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012473 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012474
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012475 Example:
12476
12477 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012478 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012479
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012480 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012481 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012482 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012483 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12484 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012485 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012486 tcp-request content reject
12487
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012488 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12489 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12490 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12491 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12492 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12493 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12494 ...
12495 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12496
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012497 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012498 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12499 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012500 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012501 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012502
12503 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12504 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012505 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012506 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012507 tcp-request content reject
12508
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012509 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012510 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012511 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012512 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012513 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12514 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012515
12516 Example:
12517 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12518 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012519 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012520
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012521 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012522 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012523
12524 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012525 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012526 # protecting all our sites
12527 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012528 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12529 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012530 ...
12531 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12532
12533 backend http_dynamic
12534 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012535 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012536 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012537 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012538 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012539 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012540 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012542 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012543
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012544 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12545 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012546
12547
12548tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12549 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012551 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012552 Arguments :
12553 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12554 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12555 as explained at the top of this document.
12556
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012557 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012558 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12559 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12560 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12561 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12562
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012563 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12564 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12565 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12566 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12567
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012568 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012569 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012570 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012571 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012572 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012573 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12574 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12575 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012576
Christopher Faulet3e2a39e2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020012577 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
12578 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
12579
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012580 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12581 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12582 it pass through unaffected.
12583
12584 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12585 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12586 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012587 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012588 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12589 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012590 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12591 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12592 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012593
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012594 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012595 "timeout client".
12596
12597
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012598tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12599 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12601 no | no | yes | yes
12602 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012603 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12604 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012605
12606 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12607
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012608 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012609 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12610 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012611 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12612 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012613
12614 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12615
12616 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12617 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12618 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12619 inserted.
12620
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012621 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012622 - accept :
12623 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12624 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12625 the rules evaluation.
12626
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012627 - close :
12628 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12629 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12630 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12631 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12632 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12633 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012634 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012635 protocols.
12636
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012637 - reject :
12638 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12639 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012640 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012641
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012642 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012643 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012644
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012645 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12646 Unsets a variable.
12647
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012648 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12649 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12650 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12651 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12652
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012653 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12654 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12655 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12656 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12657
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012658 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12659 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12660 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12661 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12662 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012663
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012664 - "silent-drop" :
12665 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012666 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012667 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12668 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12669 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12670 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12671 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012672 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12673 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012674 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12675 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012676 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012677 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12678 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12679 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12680 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12681
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012682 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12683 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12684
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012685 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12686 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12687 for changing the default action to a reject.
12688
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012689 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12690 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12691 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12692 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012693 period.
12694
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012695 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12696 declared inline.
12697
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012698 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12699 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012700 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012701 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12702 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012703 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012704 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012705 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012706 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12707 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012708 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012709 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12710 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012711
12712 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12713 followed by some converters.
12714
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012715 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12716 <var-name>.
12717
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012718 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12719 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12720 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12721 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12722 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12723
12724 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12725
12726 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12727
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012728 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12729
12730 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12731
12732
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012733tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12734 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12736 no | yes | yes | no
12737 Arguments :
12738 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12739 below.
12740
12741 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12742
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012743 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012744 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12745 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12746 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12747 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12748 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12749 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12750 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012751 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012752 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12753 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12754 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12755 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12756 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12757 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12758 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12759 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12760 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12761 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12762 instead.
12763
12764 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12765 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12766 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12767 rules which may be inserted.
12768
12769 Several types of actions are supported :
12770 - accept : the request is accepted
12771 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12772 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12773 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012774 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012775 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012776 - set-dst <expr>
12777 - set-dst-port <expr>
12778 - set-src <expr>
12779 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012780 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012781 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012782 - silent-drop
12783
12784 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12785 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12786 sections for a complete description.
12787
12788 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12789 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12790 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12791
12792 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12793 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12794 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12795 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12796 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12797
12798 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12799 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12800
12801 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12802 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12803 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12804
12805 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12806 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12807 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12808
12809 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12810 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12811 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12812
12813 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12814 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12815 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12816
12817 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12818
12819 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12820
12821
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012822tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12823 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12825 no | no | yes | yes
12826 Arguments :
12827 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12828 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12829 as explained at the top of this document.
12830
12831 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12832
12833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012834timeout check <timeout>
12835 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12836 established.
12837
12838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12839 yes | no | yes | yes
12840 Arguments:
12841 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12842 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12843 as explained at the top of this document.
12844
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012845 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012846 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012847 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012848 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012849 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12850 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12851 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012852
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012853 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012854 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12855
12856 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12857 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012858 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012859
12860 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12861 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12862 forget about it.
12863
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012864 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12865 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012866
12867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012868timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012869 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12871 yes | yes | yes | no
12872 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012873 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012874 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12875 as explained at the top of this document.
12876
12877 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12878 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12879 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012880 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12881 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12882 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12883 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012884 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12885 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12886 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012887 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012888 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012889 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12890 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012891 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12892 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012893
12894 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12895 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12896 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12897 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012898 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012899 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12900
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012901 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012902
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012903
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012904timeout client-fin <timeout>
12905 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12907 yes | yes | yes | no
12908 Arguments :
12909 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12910 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12911 as explained at the top of this document.
12912
12913 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12914 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12915 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12916 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12917 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12918 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12919 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012920 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12921 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12922 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012923
12924 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12925 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12926 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12927
12928 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12929
12930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012931timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012932 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12934 yes | no | yes | yes
12935 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012936 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012937 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12938 as explained at the top of this document.
12939
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012940 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012941 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012942 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012943 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012944 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12945 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012946
12947 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12948 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12949 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12950 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012951 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012952 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12953
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012954 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012956
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012957timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12958 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12960 yes | yes | yes | yes
12961 Arguments :
12962 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12963 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12964 as explained at the top of this document.
12965
12966 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12967 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12968 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12969 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12970 once the request has started to present itself.
12971
12972 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12973 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12974 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12975 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12976 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12977
12978 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12979 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12980 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12981 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12982
12983 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12984 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012985 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012986 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12987 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012988 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012989
12990 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12991 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12992 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12993 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12994
12995 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12996
12997
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012998timeout http-request <timeout>
12999 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013001 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013002 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013003 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013004 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13005 as explained at the top of this document.
13006
13007 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13008 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13009 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13010 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13011 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13012 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13013 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013014 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13015 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13016 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13017 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013018 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013019 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13020 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013021
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013022 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13023 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13024 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13025 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13026 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013027 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013028
13029 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13030 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013031 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013032 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13033 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13034
13035 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013036 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13037 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13038 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013039
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013040 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013041 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013042
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013043
13044timeout queue <timeout>
13045 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13047 yes | no | yes | yes
13048 Arguments :
13049 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13050 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13051 as explained at the top of this document.
13052
13053 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13054 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13055 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13056 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13057 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13058
13059 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13060 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13061 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13062 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13063
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013064 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013065
13066
13067timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013068 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13070 yes | no | yes | yes
13071 Arguments :
13072 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13073 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13074 as explained at the top of this document.
13075
13076 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13077 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13078 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13079 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13080 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13081 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13082 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13083
13084 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13085 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13086 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13087 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13088 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013089 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013090 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013091 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13092 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013093 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13094 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013095
13096 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13097 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13098 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13099 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013100 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013101 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13102
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013103 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013104
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013105
13106timeout server-fin <timeout>
13107 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13109 yes | no | yes | yes
13110 Arguments :
13111 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13112 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13113 as explained at the top of this document.
13114
13115 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13116 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13117 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13118 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13119 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13120 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13121 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13122 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13123 situations, it should not be needed.
13124
13125 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13126 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13127 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13128
13129 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13130
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013131
13132timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013133 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13135 yes | yes | yes | yes
13136 Arguments :
13137 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13138 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13139 as explained at the top of this document.
13140
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013141 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13142 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13143 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013144
13145 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13146 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13147 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13148 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013149 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013150
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013151 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013152
13153
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013154timeout tunnel <timeout>
13155 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13157 yes | no | yes | yes
13158 Arguments :
13159 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13160 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13161 as explained at the top of this document.
13162
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013163 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013164 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13165 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13166 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013167 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13168 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013169 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13170 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13171 specified.
13172
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013173 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13174 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13175 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13176 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13177 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13178 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13179 state.
13180
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013181 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13182 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13183 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13184 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013185 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013186
13187 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13188 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13189 forget about it.
13190
13191 Example :
13192 defaults http
13193 option http-server-close
13194 timeout connect 5s
13195 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013196 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013197 timeout server 30s
13198 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13199
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013200 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013201
13202
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013203transparent (deprecated)
13204 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013206 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013207 Arguments : none
13208
13209 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13210 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13211 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13212 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13213 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13214 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13215 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13216 appropriate server.
13217
13218 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13219
13220 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13221 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13222
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013223 See also: "option transparent"
13224
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013225unique-id-format <string>
13226 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13228 yes | yes | yes | no
13229 Arguments :
13230 <string> is a log-format string.
13231
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013232 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13233 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13234 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13235 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013236
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013237 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013238 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013239 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13240 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13241 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13242 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13243 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13244 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013245
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013246 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13247 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013248
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013249 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013250
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013251 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013252
13253 will generate:
13254
13255 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13256
13257 See also: "unique-id-header"
13258
13259unique-id-header <name>
13260 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13262 yes | yes | yes | no
13263 Arguments :
13264 <name> is the name of the header.
13265
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013266 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13267 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013268
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013269 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013270
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013271 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013272 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13273
13274 will generate:
13275
13276 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13277
13278 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013279
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013280use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013281 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13283 no | yes | yes | no
13284 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013285 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13286 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013287
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013288 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13289 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013290
13291 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13292 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13293 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013294 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013295 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013296 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13297 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013298
13299 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13300 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13301 assign the backend.
13302
13303 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13304 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13305 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13306 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13307 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13308 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13309
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013310 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013311 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013312 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13313 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13314 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13315
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013316 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13317 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13318 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13319 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13320 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13321 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13322 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13323 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13324 cannot be forced from the request.
13325
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013326 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013327 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13328 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13329
13330 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13331 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013332
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013333use-fcgi-app <name>
13334 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13336 no | no | yes | yes
13337 Arguments :
13338 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13339
13340 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013341
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013342use-server <server> if <condition>
13343use-server <server> unless <condition>
13344 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13346 no | no | yes | yes
13347 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013348 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13349 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013350
13351 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13352
13353 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13354 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13355 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13356
13357 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13358 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13359 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13360 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13361 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13362 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13363 matches will assign the server.
13364
13365 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13366 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13367 with the next rules until one matches.
13368
13369 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13370 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13371 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13372 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13373
13374 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13375 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13376 stripped.
13377
13378 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13379 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013380 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013381 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013382 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013383
13384 Example :
13385 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013386 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013387 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013388 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013389 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013390 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013391 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013392 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13393 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13394
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013395 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13396 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13397 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13398 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013399 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013400 and we fall back to load balancing.
13401
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013402 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013403
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013404
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134055. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013406--------------------------
13407
13408The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13409depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13410settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13411written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13412described in this section.
13413
13414
134155.1. Bind options
13416-----------------
13417
13418The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13419as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13420no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13421parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13422while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13423provided immediately after the setting name.
13424
13425The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13426
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013427accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13428 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13429 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13430 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13431 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13432 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13433 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13434 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13435 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13436 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013437 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13438 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13439 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013440
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013441accept-proxy
13442 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013443 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13444 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013445 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13446 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13447 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13448 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013449 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013450 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13451 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013452 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13453 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013454
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013455allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013456 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013457 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013458 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013459 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13460 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013461
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013462alpn <protocols>
13463 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13464 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13465 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013466 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013467 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013468 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13469 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13470 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13471 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13472 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13473 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13474 preference, like below :
13475
13476 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013477
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013478backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013479 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013480 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13481
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013482curves <curves>
13483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13484 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13485 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13486 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13487 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13488 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13489
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013490ecdhe <named curve>
13491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013492 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13493 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013494
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013495ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13497 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13498 client's certificate.
13499
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013500ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13501 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13502 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13503 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13504 error is ignored.
13505
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013506ca-sign-file <cafile>
13507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13508 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13509 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13510 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13511 'generate-certificates' for details.
13512
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013513ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013514 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13515 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13516 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13517 'generate-certificates' for details.
13518
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013519ca-verify-file <cafile>
13520 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13521 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13522 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13523 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13524 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13525
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013526ciphers <ciphers>
13527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13528 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013529 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013530 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013531 information and recommendations see e.g.
13532 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13533 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13534 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13535
13536ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13537 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13538 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13539 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13540 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013541 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13542 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013543
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013544crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13546 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013547 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13548 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013549
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013550crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13552 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13553 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13554 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13555 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013556 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13557 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013558
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013559 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13560 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13561
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013562 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13563 are loaded.
13564
13565 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013566 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13567 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13568 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13569 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13570 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13571 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13572 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013573 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used,
13574 HAProxy will not start unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013575
13576 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13577 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13578 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13579 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013580 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13581 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013582
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013583 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013584
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013585 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013586 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013587 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13588 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013589 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13590 clients).
13591
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013592 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013593 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13594 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13595 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13596 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13597 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13598 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13599 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13600 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13601 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13602 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13603 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13604 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13605
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013606 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013607 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13608 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13609 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13610 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13611
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013612 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13613 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13614 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13615 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013616
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013617 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13618 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13619 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013620
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013621crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013623 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013624 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013625 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013626
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013627crt-list <file>
13628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013629 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13630 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013631
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013632 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13633
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013634 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13635 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13636 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13637 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13638 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013639
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013640 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013641 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13642 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13643 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13644 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13645 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013646 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13647 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13648 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013649
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013650 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13651 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13652 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013653
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013654 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13655
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013656 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013657 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013658 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13659 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13660 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13661 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13662 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13663 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013664
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013665 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013666 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013667 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013668 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013669 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013670 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013671
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013672defer-accept
13673 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13674 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13675 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013676 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013677 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13678 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13679 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13680 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13681 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13682 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13683 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13684
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013685expose-fd listeners
13686 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13687 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013688 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13689 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013690 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013691
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013692force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013693 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013694 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013695 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013696 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013697
13698force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013699 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013700 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013701 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013702
13703force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013704 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013705 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013706 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013707
13708force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013709 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013710 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013711 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013712
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013713force-tlsv13
13714 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13715 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013716 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013717
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013718generate-certificates
13719 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13720 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13721 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13722 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13723 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13724 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13725 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13726 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13727 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13728 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13729 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13730
13731 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13732 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013733 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013734 certificate is used many times.
13735
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013736gid <gid>
13737 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13738 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13739 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13740 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13741 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13742
13743group <group>
13744 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13745 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13746 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13747 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13748 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13749
13750id <id>
13751 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13752 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13753 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13754 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13755
13756interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013757 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13758 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13759 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13760 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13761 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13762 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013763 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13764 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13765 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13766 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13767 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13768 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013769
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013770level <level>
13771 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13772 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13773 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013774 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013775 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13776 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13777 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013778 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013779 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013780 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013781 all counters).
13782
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013783severity-output <format>
13784 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13785 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13786 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13787 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13788 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13789 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13790 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13791 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13792 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13793 rfc5424 convention.
13794
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013795maxconn <maxconn>
13796 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13797 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13798 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13799 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13800 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13801 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13802 eat all memory.
13803
13804mode <mode>
13805 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13806 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13807 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13808 UNIX sockets.
13809
13810mss <maxseg>
13811 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13812 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13813 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13814 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13815 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13816 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13817 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13818 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13819 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13820 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13821 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13822
13823name <name>
13824 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13825 page.
13826
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013827namespace <name>
13828 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13829 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13830 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13831 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13832
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013833nice <nice>
13834 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13835 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13836 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13837 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13838 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13839 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13840 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13841 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13842 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13843 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13844 one for an RDP socket.
13845
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013846no-ca-names
13847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13848 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013849 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013850
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013851no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013853 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013854 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013855 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013856 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13857 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013858
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013859no-tls-tickets
13860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13861 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13862 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013863 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13864 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013865 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13866 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13867 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013868
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013869no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013871 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013872 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013873 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013874 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13875 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013876
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013877no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013879 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013880 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013881 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013882 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13883 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013884
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013885no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013887 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013888 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013889 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013890 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13891 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013892
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013893no-tlsv13
13894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13895 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13896 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13897 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013898 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13899 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013900
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013901npn <protocols>
13902 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13903 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13904 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013905 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013906 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013907 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13908 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13909 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13910 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13911 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013912
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013913prefer-client-ciphers
13914 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13915 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13916 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013917 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13918 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13919 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013920
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013921process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013922 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013923 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013924 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013925 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13926 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13927 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13928 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013929 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013930 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13931 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13932 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13933 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13934 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013935
13936 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13937
13938 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13939 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13940 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13941 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13942 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13943 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13944 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13945 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013946
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013947proto <name>
13948 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13949 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13950 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013951 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13952 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13953
13954 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13955 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13956 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13957 also reported (flag=HTX).
13958
13959 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13960 a bind line :
13961
13962 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13963 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13964 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13965
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013966 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013967 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013968 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013969 h2" on the bind line.
13970
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013971ssl
13972 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013973 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013974 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13975 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013976 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13977 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013978
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013979ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13980 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013981 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13982 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13983 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013984 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13985
13986ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013987 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13988 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13989 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13990 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013991
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013992strict-sni
13993 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13994 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013995 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
13996 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
13997 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
13998 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
13999 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014000
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014001tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014002 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014003 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014004 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014005 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014006 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14007 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14008 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14009 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14010 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14011 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14012 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14013
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014014tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014015 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014016 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14017 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14018 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14019 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14020 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14021 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14022 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014023 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14024 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14025 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014026
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014027tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14028 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014029 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14030 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14031 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14032 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14033 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14034 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14035 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14036 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14037 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14038 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014039 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14040 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14041
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014042transparent
14043 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14044 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14045 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14046 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14047 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14048 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14049 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14050 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14051 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14052 so check for support with your vendor.
14053
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014054v4v6
14055 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14056 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14057 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14058 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014059 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014060
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014061v6only
14062 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14063 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14064 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014065 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14066 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014067
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014068uid <uid>
14069 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14070 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14071 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14072 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14073 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14074
14075user <user>
14076 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14077 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14078 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14079 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14080 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14081
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014082verify [none|optional|required]
14083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14084 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14085 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14086 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14087 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014088 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14089 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14090 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14091 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014092
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140935.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014094------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014096The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14097which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14098arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14099settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14100after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14101Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14102address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014104 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014105 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014106
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014107Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14108keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14109
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014110The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014111
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014112addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014113 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014114 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14115 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14116 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14117 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14118 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014119
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014120agent-check
14121 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014122 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014123 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14124 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14125 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014126
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014127 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014128 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014129 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014130 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14131 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014133 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14134 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14135 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14136 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14137 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014138
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014139 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014140 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014141
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014142 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14143 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14144 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014145
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014146 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14147 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14148 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014149
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014150 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014151 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14152 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14153 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14154 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014155 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014156 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014157
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014158 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14159 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014160
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014161 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14162 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14163 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14164 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14165 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14166 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14167 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14168 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14169 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014170
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014171 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14172 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014173 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14174 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14175 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014176 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014177
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014178 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014179 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014180
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014181agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014182 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014183 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14184 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14185 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14186 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14187
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014188agent-inter <delay>
14189 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14190 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14191
14192 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14193 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14194 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14195 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14196 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14197 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14198 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14199 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14200 of backends use the same servers.
14201
14202 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14203
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014204agent-addr <addr>
14205 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14206
14207 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014208 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014209 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14210 hostname, it will be resolved.
14211
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014212agent-port <port>
14213 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14214
14215 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14216
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014217allow-0rtt
14218 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014219 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14220 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014221
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014222alpn <protocols>
14223 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14224 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14225 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014226 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014227 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14228 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14229 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14230 now obsolete NPN extension.
14231 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14232 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14233
14234 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14235
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014236 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014238backup
14239 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14240 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14241 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14242 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014243 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14244 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014245
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014246ca-file <cafile>
14247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14248 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14249 server's certificate.
14250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014251check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014252 This option enables health checks on a server:
14253 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14254 considered available.
14255 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14256 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14257 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14258 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14259 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14260 set.
14261 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14262 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14263 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14264 exchanges succeed.
14265
14266 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14267 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14268 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14269 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14270 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014271 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014272 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14273
14274 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14275 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14276
14277 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14278 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14279
14280 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14281 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14282 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14283 available.
14284
14285 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14286 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14287 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14288
14289 Example:
14290 # simple tcp check
14291 backend foo
14292 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14293 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14294 backend foo
14295 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14296 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14297 backend foo
14298 option tcp-check
14299 tcp-check connect
14300 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014301
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014302check-send-proxy
14303 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14304 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14305 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14306 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14307 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14308 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14309 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14310
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014311check-alpn <protocols>
14312 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14313 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14314 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14315
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014316check-proto <name>
14317 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14318 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14319 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014320 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14321 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14322
14323 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14324 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14325 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14326 also reported (flag=HTX).
14327
14328 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14329 directive on a server line:
14330
14331 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14332 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14333 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14334 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14335
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014336 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014337 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14338 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14339
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014340check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014341 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014342 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14343 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014344
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014345check-ssl
14346 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14347 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14348 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14349 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014350 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014351 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14352 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014353 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014354 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14355 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014356
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014357check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014358 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014359 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14360 for normal traffic.
14361
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014362ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14364 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14365 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014366 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14367 information and recommendations see e.g.
14368 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14369 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14370 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014371
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014372ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14373 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14374 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14375 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14376 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014377 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14378 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14379 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014381cookie <value>
14382 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14383 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14384 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14385 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14386 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14387 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14388 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14389
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014390crl-file <crlfile>
14391 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14392 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14393 to verify server's certificate.
14394
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014395crt <cert>
14396 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14397 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14398 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14399 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14400 certificate request.
14401
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014402 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14403 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14404 option is set accordingly).
14405
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014406disabled
14407 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14408 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14409 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14410 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14411 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014412 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014413
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014414enabled
14415 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14416 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14417 default value.
14418 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14419 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014421error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014422 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14423 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14424 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014426 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014428fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014429 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14430 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14431 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14432
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014433force-sslv3
14434 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14435 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014436 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014437 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014438
14439force-tlsv10
14440 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014441 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014442 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014443
14444force-tlsv11
14445 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014446 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014447 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014448
14449force-tlsv12
14450 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014451 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014452 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014453
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014454force-tlsv13
14455 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14456 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014457 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014459id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014460 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14461 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14462 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014463
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014464init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14465 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14466 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014467 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014468 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14469 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14470 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14471 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14472 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14473 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14474 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14475 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14476 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014477 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014478 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14479 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14480 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14481 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14482 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14483 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014484 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014485
14486 Example:
14487 defaults
14488 # never fail on address resolution
14489 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014491inter <delay>
14492fastinter <delay>
14493downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014494 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14495 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14496 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14497 between checks depending on the server state :
14498
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014499 Server state | Interval used
14500 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14501 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14502 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14503 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14504 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14505 or yet unchecked. |
14506 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14507 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14508 | "inter" otherwise.
14509 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014511 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14512 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14513 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14514 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014515 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14516 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14517 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14518 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14519 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014520
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014521log-proto <logproto>
14522 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14523 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14524 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14525 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014527maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014528 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14529 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014530 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14531 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014532 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14533 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14534 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14535 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14536
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014537 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14538 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14539 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14540 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14541 than 50 concurrent requests.
14542
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014543maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014544 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14545 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14546 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14547 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014548 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14549 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14550 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14551 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14552 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14553 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14554 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014555
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014556max-reuse <count>
14557 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14558 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14559 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14560 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14561 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14562 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14563 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14564 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014566minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014567 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14568 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14569 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14570 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14571 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14572 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014573 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014574 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014575
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014576namespace <name>
14577 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14578 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14579 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14580 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14581
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014582no-agent-check
14583 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14584 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14585 default value.
14586 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14587 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14588
14589no-backup
14590 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14591 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14592 default value.
14593 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14594 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14595
14596no-check
14597 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14598 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14599 default value.
14600 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14601 "default-server" "check" setting.
14602
14603no-check-ssl
14604 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14605 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14606 default value.
14607 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14608 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14609
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014610no-send-proxy
14611 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14612 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14613 default value.
14614 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14615 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14616
14617no-send-proxy-v2
14618 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14619 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14620 default value.
14621 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14622 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14623
14624no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14625 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14626 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14627 default value.
14628 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14629 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14630
14631no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14632 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14633 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14634 default value.
14635 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14636 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14637
14638no-ssl
14639 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14640 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14641 default value.
14642 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14643 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14644
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014645 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14646 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14647 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14648
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014649no-ssl-reuse
14650 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14651 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14652 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14653 and for paranoid users.
14654
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014655no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014656 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14657 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014658 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014659
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014660 Supported in default-server: No
14661
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014662no-tls-tickets
14663 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14664 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14665 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014666 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14667 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014668 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14669 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14670 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014671 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014672
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014673no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014674 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014675 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14676 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014677 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14678 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014679 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014680
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014681 Supported in default-server: No
14682
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014683no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014684 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014685 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14686 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014687 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14688 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014689 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014690
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014691 Supported in default-server: No
14692
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014693no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014694 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014695 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14696 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014697 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14698 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014699 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014700
14701 Supported in default-server: No
14702
14703no-tlsv13
14704 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14705 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14706 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14707 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14708 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014709 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014710
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014711 Supported in default-server: No
14712
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014713no-verifyhost
14714 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14715 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14716 default value.
14717 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14718 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014719
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014720no-tfo
14721 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14722 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14723 default value.
14724 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14725 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14726
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014727non-stick
14728 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14729 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14730 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14731
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014732npn <protocols>
14733 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14734 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14735 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014736 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014737 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14738 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14739 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014741observe <mode>
14742 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14743 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14744 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14745 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14746 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14747 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014748 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014749
14750 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014752on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014753 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14754 Currently, four modes are available:
14755 - fastinter: force fastinter
14756 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14757 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14758 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14759 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14760
14761 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14762
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014763on-marked-down <action>
14764 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14765 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014766 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14767 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14768 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14769 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14770 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14771 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14772 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14773 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014774
14775 Actions are disabled by default
14776
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014777on-marked-up <action>
14778 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14779 Currently one action is available:
14780 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14781 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14782 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14783 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014784 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14785 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014786 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14787 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14788
14789 Actions are disabled by default
14790
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014791pool-low-conn <max>
14792 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14793 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14794 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14795 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14796 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14797 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14798 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14799 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14800 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14801 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014802 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14803 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14804 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14805 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014806
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014807pool-max-conn <max>
14808 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14809 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14810 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14811 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14812 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14813 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14814
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014815pool-purge-delay <delay>
14816 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014817 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014818 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014820port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014821 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014822 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14823 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14824 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14825 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14826 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014827
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014828proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014829 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14830 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14831 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014832 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14833 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14834
14835 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14836 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14837 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14838 also reported (flag=HTX).
14839
14840 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14841 a server line :
14842
14843 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14844 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14845 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14846 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14847
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014848 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014849 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14850
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014851 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014853redir <prefix>
14854 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14855 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14856 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14857 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14858 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14859 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14860 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14861 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014862 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014863 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014864 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14865 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14866 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14867 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14868
14869 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014871rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014872 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14873 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14874 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14875
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014876resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14877 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14878 server.
14879
14880 Available options:
14881
14882 * allow-dup-ip
14883 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14884 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14885 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14886 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14887 For such case, simply enable this option.
14888 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14889
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014890 * ignore-weight
14891 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14892 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14893 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14894
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014895 * prevent-dup-ip
14896 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14897 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14898 same fqdn.
14899 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14900
14901 Example:
14902 backend b_myapp
14903 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14904 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14905 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14906
14907 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14908 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14909 it
14910 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14911 different address
14912
14913 Default value: not set
14914
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014915resolve-prefer <family>
14916 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14917 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14918 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14919 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14920
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014921 Default value: ipv6
14922
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014923 Example:
14924
14925 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014926
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014927resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014928 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014929 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014930 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014931 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14932 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014933 configured network, another address is selected.
14934
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014935 Example:
14936
14937 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014938
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014939resolvers <id>
14940 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14941 hostname.
14942
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014943 Example:
14944
14945 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014946
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014947 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014948
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014949send-proxy
14950 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14951 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14952 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14953 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014954 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14955 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14956 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14957 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014958 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014959 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14960 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14961 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14962 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14963 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014964 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14965 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014966
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014967send-proxy-v2
14968 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14969 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14970 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14971 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014972 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14973 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14974 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14975 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014976
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014977proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014978 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14979 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14980
14981 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14982 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14983 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14984 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14985 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14986 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14987 connection is supported).
14988 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14989 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14990 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14991 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14992 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14993 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14994 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014995
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014996send-proxy-v2-ssl
14997 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14998 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14999 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15000 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15001 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15002 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15003 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015004 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15005 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015006
15007send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15008 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15009 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15010 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15011 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15012 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15013 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15014 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15015 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015016 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15017 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015019slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015020 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15021 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15022 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15023 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15024 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15025 parameters :
15026
15027 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15028 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15029
15030 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15031 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15032 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15033 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15034
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015035 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015036 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15037 seen as failed.
15038
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015039sni <expression>
15040 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15041 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15042 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015043 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15044 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15045 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15046 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015047 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015048 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015049 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15050 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015051
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015052source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015053source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015054source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015055 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15056 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15057 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15058 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15059
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015060 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15061 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15062 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15063 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15064 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15065 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15066 server.
15067
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015068 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15069 specifying the source address without port(s).
15070
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015071ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015072 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15073 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15074 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15075 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15076 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15077 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015078 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15079 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015080
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015081ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15082 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15083 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15084 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15085
15086ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15087 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15088 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15089 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15090
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015091ssl-reuse
15092 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15093 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15094 default value.
15095 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15096 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15097
15098stick
15099 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15100 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15101 default value.
15102 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15103 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015104
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015105socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015106 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015107 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15108 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15109
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015110tcp-ut <delay>
15111 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015112 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015113 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015114 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015115 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15116 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15117 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15118 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15119 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15120 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15121 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15122 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15123 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15124
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015125tfo
15126 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15127 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15128 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15129 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015130 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015131 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015132
Willy Tarreau42bd5cb2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010015133track [<backend>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015134 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15135 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15136 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
Willy Tarreau42bd5cb2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010015137 enabled. If <backend> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015138 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15139
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015140tls-tickets
15141 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15142 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15143 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015144 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15145 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15146 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015147 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015148 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015149
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015150verify [none|required]
15151 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015152 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015153 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15154 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015155 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015156 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15157 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15158 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15159 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15160 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15161 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15162 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15163 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015164
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015165verifyhost <hostname>
15166 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015167 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15168 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15169 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15170 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15171 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15172 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15173 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15174 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015176weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015177 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15178 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15179 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015180 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15181 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15182 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15183 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15184 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15185 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015186
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015187ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15188 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15189 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15190 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15191
15192 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15193 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15194 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15195 server ALPN contains it.
15196
15197 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15198 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15199 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15200 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15201
15202 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15203 favor of the ALPN extension.
15204
15205 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015207
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152085.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15209-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015210
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015211HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15212using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015213configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015214This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15215can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15216workload.
15217This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15218resolution at run time.
15219Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15220carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15221
15222
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152235.3.1. Global overview
15224----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015225
15226As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15227different steps of the process life:
15228
15229 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15230 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15231 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15232
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015233 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15234 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015235
15236A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15237 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15238 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15239 resolution to know this new IP.
15240
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015241When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015242HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015243SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15244from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015245will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015246will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015247
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015248A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015249 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015250 first valid response.
15251
15252 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15253 servers return an error.
15254
15255
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152565.3.2. The resolvers section
15257----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015258
15259This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015260HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15261contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015262
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015263When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15264uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15265is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15266answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15267
15268When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015269used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015270
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015271 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15272 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15273 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015274
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015275 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15276 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015277
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015278 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015279 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15280 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015281
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015282For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15283following scenarios are possible:
15284
15285 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15286 ignored
15287
15288 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15289 applied
15290
15291 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15292 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15293
15294 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15295 retries the query with a new type
15296
15297 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15298 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015299
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015300As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015301a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015302<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015303
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015304
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015305resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015306 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015307
15308A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15309
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015310accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015311 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015312 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015313 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15314 by RFC 6891)
15315
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015316 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15317 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15318 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15319 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15320 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15321 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015322
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015323nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15324 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15325 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15326 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15327 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15328 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15329 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15330 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15331 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15332 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015333 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15334
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015335parse-resolv-conf
15336 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15337 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15338 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15339
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015340hold <status> <period>
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015341 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
15342 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
15343 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
15344 counteract the just received invalid status.
15345
15346 <status> : last name resolution status.
15347 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
15348 status during the concluding period.
15349
15350 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
15351 status during the concluding period.
15352
15353 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
15354 valid status during the concluding period.
15355
15356 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
15357 valid status during the concluding period.
15358
15359 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
15360 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
15361 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
15362 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
15363 dynamic resolution of servers.
15364
15365 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
15366 records after an updated answer record is received. It
15367 applies to SRV records.
15368
15369 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
15370 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
15371 milliseconds by default.
15372
15373 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
15374 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
15375 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
15376 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
15377 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
15378
15379 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
15380 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
15381 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
15382 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
15383
15384 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
15385 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015386
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015387 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015388
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015389resolve_retries <nb>
15390 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15391 giving up.
15392 Default value: 3
15393
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015394 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15395 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15396 type.
15397
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015398timeout <event> <time>
15399 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15400 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15401 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015402 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15403 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015404 Default value: 1s
15405 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015406 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015407 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015408 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15409 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15410
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015411 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015412
15413 resolvers mydns
15414 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15415 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015416 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015417 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015418 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015419 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015420 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015421 hold other 30s
15422 hold refused 30s
15423 hold nx 30s
15424 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015425 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015426 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015427
15428
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200154296. Cache
15430---------
15431
15432HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15433(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15434RAM.
15435
15436The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15437this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15438
15439If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15440independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15441when we try to allocate a new one.
15442
15443The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15444
15445It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15446"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15447for more details.
15448
15449When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15450replaced by "<CACHE>".
15451
15452
154536.1. Limitation
15454----------------
15455
15456The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15457
15458- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015459- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15460 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15461 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015462- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15463- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015464- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15465 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15466 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015467- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15468 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015469- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15470 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15471 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015472
15473- If the request is not a GET
15474- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15475- If the request contains an Authorization header
15476
15477
154786.2. Setup
15479-----------
15480
15481To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15482the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15483
15484
154856.2.1. Cache section
15486---------------------
15487
15488cache <name>
15489 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15490 size of cache is mandatory.
15491
15492total-max-size <megabytes>
15493 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15494 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15495
15496max-object-size <bytes>
15497 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15498 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15499 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15500
15501max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015502 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015503 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15504 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15505 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15506 default.
15507
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015508process-vary <on/off>
15509 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015510 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15511 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15512 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015513 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015514
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015515max-secondary-entries <number>
15516 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15517 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15518 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15519
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015520
155216.2.2. Proxy section
15522---------------------
15523
15524http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15525 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15526 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15527 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15528 after this one.
15529
15530http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15531 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15532 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15533 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15534 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15535
15536
15537Example:
15538
15539 backend bck1
15540 mode http
15541
15542 http-request cache-use foobar
15543 http-response cache-store foobar
15544 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15545
15546 cache foobar
15547 total-max-size 4
15548 max-age 240
15549
15550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155517. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15552----------------------------------
15553
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015554HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15556The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15557these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15558but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15559data called patterns.
15560
15561
155627.1. ACL basics
15563---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015564
15565The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15566content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15567from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15568simple :
15569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015571 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15573 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15576adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015577
15578In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015580 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015581
15582This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15583Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15584and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015585an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15586conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15587as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15588are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015589
15590ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15591'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15592which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15593
15594There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15595performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15598specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15599this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015600methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15601ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602
15603Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15604 - boolean
15605 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15606 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15607 - string
15608 - data block
15609
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015610Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15611converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15612would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15613The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15614which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15615
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015616Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15617keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15618fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15619which are summarized in the table below :
15620
15621 +---------------------+-----------------+
15622 | Sample or converter | Default |
15623 | output type | matching method |
15624 +---------------------+-----------------+
15625 | boolean | bool |
15626 +---------------------+-----------------+
15627 | integer | int |
15628 +---------------------+-----------------+
15629 | ip | ip |
15630 +---------------------+-----------------+
15631 | string | str |
15632 +---------------------+-----------------+
15633 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15634 +---------------------+-----------------+
15635
15636Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15637matching method, see below.
15638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15640 - boolean
15641 - integer or integer range
15642 - IP address / network
15643 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15644 - regular expression
15645 - hex block
15646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015647The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15648
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015649 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15650 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015652 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015653 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015654 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015655 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15658read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15659if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15660lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15661will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15662beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015663a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15665exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15666
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015667The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15668parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15669ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15670a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15671check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15672
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015673The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15674socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15675file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15678loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15679
15680 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15681
15682In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15683the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15684case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15685as well.
15686
15687The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15688sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15689do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15690methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15691is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015692obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15694default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15695that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15696string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15697
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015698The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15699By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15700string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15701resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015702server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015703waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015704flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15705function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15708sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15709be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015710
15711 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15712 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15714 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15715 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15716 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015717
15718 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15719 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015721
15722 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015724
15725 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015727
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015728 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015729 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15730
15731 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15732 binary or string samples.
15733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15735 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15738 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15739 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15742 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15745 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15748 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015750 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15751 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015752 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15755 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15756 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015757
15758For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15759request, it is possible to do :
15760
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015761 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015762
15763In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15764buffer, one would use the following acl :
15765
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015766 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015767
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015768On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15769possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15770
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015771 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015773All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15774criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15775method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreauedbeab12022-11-25 10:49:41 +010015776to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
15777usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
15778converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
15779method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
15780matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015781criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15782the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015784If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015785the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15786For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15789 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15790 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15791 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015792
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015793
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015794The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15795types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15796combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15797brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15798default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800 +-------------------------------------------------+
15801 | Input sample type |
15802 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015803 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15805 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15806 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015807 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015809 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015811 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015813 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015815 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015816 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015817 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015819 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015820 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015821 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015822 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015823 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015824 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015825 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015827 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15829 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15830 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015831
15832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158337.1.1. Matching booleans
15834------------------------
15835
15836In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15837Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15838When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15839that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15840
15841Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15842return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15843"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15844
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158467.1.2. Matching integers
15847------------------------
15848
15849Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15850enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15851to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15852
15853Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15854matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15855lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015856
15857For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15858unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15859representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15860
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015861As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15862two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15863instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15864ranges and operators.
15865
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015866For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015867operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15868Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15869of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015871Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015872
15873 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15874 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15875 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15876 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15877 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15878
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015879For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015880
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015881 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015882
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015883This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15884
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015885 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015886
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158887.1.3. Matching strings
15889-----------------------
15890
15891String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15892different forms :
15893
15894 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015895 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896
15897 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015898 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899
15900 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15901 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15902
15903 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15904 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15905
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015906 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15907 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
15908 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
15909 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
15910 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
15911 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015913 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15914 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
15915 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
15916 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
15917 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
15918 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
15919 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
15920 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
15921 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
15922 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
15923 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015924
15925String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15926exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15927characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15928string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15929to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015930before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015931
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015932Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15933(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15934Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15935
15936Example:
15937 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15938 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15939
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159417.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15942---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015943
15944Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15945they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15946possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15947passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15948the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015949the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15950match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015951
15952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159537.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15954-------------------------------------
15955
15956It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15957not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15958a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15959to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15960digits may be used upper or lower case.
15961
15962Example :
15963 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015964 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965
15966
159677.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15968---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015969
15970IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15971netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15972within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015973host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015974difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15975at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15976does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15977parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015978
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015979The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15980abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15981
15982 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15983 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15984 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15985 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15986 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15987 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15988 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15989 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15990
15991Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15992192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15993
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015994IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15995Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15996trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15997IPv6 patterns.
15998
15999HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16000following situations :
16001 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16002 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16003 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16004 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16005 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16006 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16007 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16008 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16009 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16010 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016012
160137.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16014----------------------------------
16015
16016Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16017combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16018
16019 - AND (implicit)
16020 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16021 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016025 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16028indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016030For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16031"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16032requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16033is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16034
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016035 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016036 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16037 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16038 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016039
16040To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16041and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16042
16043 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16044 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16045 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16046 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16047
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016048 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16050 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16051 use_backend www if host_www
16052
16053It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16054expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16055be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16056the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16057
16058 The following rule :
16059
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016060 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016061 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062
16063 Can also be written that way :
16064
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016065 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066
16067It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16068to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16069simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16070sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16071good use is the following :
16072
16073 With named ACLs :
16074
16075 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16076 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16077 monitor fail if site_dead
16078
16079 With anonymous ACLs :
16080
16081 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16082
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016083See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16084keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085
16086
160877.3. Fetching samples
16088---------------------
16089
16090Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16091against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16092sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16093ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16094of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16095available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16096
16097This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16098Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16099compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16100deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16101
16102The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16103matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16104method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16105indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16106
16107As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16108when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16109mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16110the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16111ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16112
16113Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16114multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16115when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016116incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16117are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16119all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16120
16121Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16122 - name
16123 - name(arg1)
16124 - name(arg1,arg2)
16125
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016126
161277.3.1. Converters
16128-----------------
16129
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016130Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16131of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16132is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16133was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016134has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016135unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16136
16137These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16138sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16139the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016140support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016141
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016142A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16143support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16144supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16145(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16146bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016149
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001615051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16151 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16152 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16153 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16154 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16155 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16156
16157 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016158 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16159 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016160 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16161 frontend http-in
16162 bind *:8081
16163 default_backend servers
16164 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16165 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16166
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016167add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016168 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016169 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016170 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16171 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016172 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016173 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16174 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16175 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16176 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016177 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016178 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016179
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016180aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16181 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16182 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16183 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16184 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16185 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16186 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16187
16188 Example:
16189 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16190 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16191
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016192and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016193 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016194 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016195 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16196 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016197 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016198 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16199 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16200 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16201 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016202 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016203 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016204
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016205b64dec
16206 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16207 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016208 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16209 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016210
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016211base64
16212 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016213 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016214 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16215 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016216
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016217bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016218 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016219 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016220 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016221 presence of a flag).
16222
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016223bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16224 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16225 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016226 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016227
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016228concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16229 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16230 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16231 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16232 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16233 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16234 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16235 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16236 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16237 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16238 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016239 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016240 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016241 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16242 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016243
16244 Example:
16245 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16246 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16247 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016248 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016249 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16250
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016251cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016252 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16253 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016254
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016255crc32([<avalanche>])
16256 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16257 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16258 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16259 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16260 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16261 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16262 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16263 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16264 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16265 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016266 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16267
16268crc32c([<avalanche>])
16269 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16270 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16271 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16272 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16273 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16274 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16275 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16276 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016277
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016278cut_crlf
16279 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16280 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16281 updated.
16282
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016283da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016284 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16285 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16286 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16287 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016288 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016289 configuration language.
16290
16291 Example:
16292 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016293 bind *:8881
16294 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016295 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016296
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016297debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16298 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16299 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16300 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16301 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16302 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16303 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16304 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16305 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16306 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16307 printable sample types.
16308
16309 Example:
16310 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016311
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016312digest(<algorithm>)
16313 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16314 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16315
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016316 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016317 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16318
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016319div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016320 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16321 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016322 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016323 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16324 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016325 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016326 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16327 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16328 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16329 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016330 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016331 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016332
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016333djb2([<avalanche>])
16334 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16335 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16336 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16337 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16338 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16339 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16340 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016341 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16342 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016343
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016344even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016345 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016346 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16347
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016348field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16349 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16350 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16351 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16352 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16353 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16354 fields.
16355
16356 Example :
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010016357 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(4,_) # <empty>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016358 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16359 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16360 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16361 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16362 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016363
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016364fix_is_valid
16365 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16366 Information eXchange):
16367
16368 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16369 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016370 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016371 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016372 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016373 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16374 checksum
16375
16376 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16377 the server can be parsed.
16378
16379 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16380 message, false if not.
16381
16382 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16383
16384 Example:
16385 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16386 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16387
16388fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16389 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16390 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16391 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16392 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016393 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016394 added.
16395
16396 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16397 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16398 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16399 fix_is_valid converter.
16400
16401 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16402
16403 Example:
16404 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16405 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16406 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16407 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16408 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16409
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016410hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016411 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016412 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016413 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016414 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016415
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016416hex2i
16417 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016418 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016419
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016420htonl
16421 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16422 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16423 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16424 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16425
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016426hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016427 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16428 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16429 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16430 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16431
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016432 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016433 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16434
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016435http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016436 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16437 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016438 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16439 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16440 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16441 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16442 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16443 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16444 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16445 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016446
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016447iif(<true>,<false>)
16448 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16449 string otherwise.
16450
16451 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016452 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016453
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016454in_table(<table>)
16455 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16456 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16457 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016458 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016459 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16460
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016461ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016462 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016463 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016464 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16465 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16466 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16467 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16468 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016469
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016470json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016471 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016472 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016473 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016474 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16475 of errors:
16476 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16477 bytes, ...)
16478 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16479 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16480
16481 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16482 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16483 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16484 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16485 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16486 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016487 - "ascii" : never fails;
16488 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16489 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016490 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016491 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016492 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16493 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16494
16495 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016496 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016497
16498 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016499 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016500 capture request header user-agent len 150
16501 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016502
16503 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16504 GET / HTTP/1.0
16505 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16506
16507 Output log:
16508 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16509
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016510json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16511 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16512 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16513 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16514 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16515
16516 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16517 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16518
16519 Example:
16520 # get a integer value from the request body
16521 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16522 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16523
16524 # get a key with '.' in the name
16525 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16526 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16527
16528 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16529 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16530
16531 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16532 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16533
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016534language(<value>[,<default>])
16535 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16536 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16537 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16538 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16539 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16540 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16541 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16542 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16543 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016544 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016545 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16546 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016547
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016548 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016549
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016550 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16551 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016552
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016553 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16554 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16555 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16556 use_backend spanish if es
16557 use_backend french if fr
16558 use_backend english if en
16559 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016560
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016561length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016562 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16563 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16564 type. The result is of type integer.
16565
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016566lower
16567 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16568 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16569 type. The result is of type string.
16570
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016571ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16572 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16573 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16574 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16575 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16576 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16577 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16578
16579 Example :
16580
16581 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016582 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016583 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16584
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016585ltrim(<chars>)
16586 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16587 representation of the input sample.
16588
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016589map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16590map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16591map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16592 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16593 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16594 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16595 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16596 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16597 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16598 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16599 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016600
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016601 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16602 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16603 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016604
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016605 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016606 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016607
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016608 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16609 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16610 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16611 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016612 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16613 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016614 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16615 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16616 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16617 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16618 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16619 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16620 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16621 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016622 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16623 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16624 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016625 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16626 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16627 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16628 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16629 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016630
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016631 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16632 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16633 the corresponding match text.
16634
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016635 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16636 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16637 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16638 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16639 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016640
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016641 Example :
16642
16643 # this is a comment and is ignored
16644 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16645 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16646 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16647 | | | `---------- value
16648 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16649 | `---------------------------- key
16650 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16651
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016652mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016653 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16654 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016655 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016656 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016657 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016658 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16659 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16660 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16661 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016662 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016663 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016664
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016665mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016666 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16667 <packettype>.
16668 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16669 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16670 from.
16671 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16672 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16673 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16674
16675 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16676 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16677 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16678 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16679
16680 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16681 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16682 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16683 packets only):
16684 17: Session Expiry Interval
16685 33: Receive Maximum
16686 39: Maximum Packet Size
16687 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16688 25: Request Response Information
16689 23: Request Problem Information
16690 21: Authentication Method
16691 22: Authentication Data
16692 18: Will Delay Interval
16693 1: Payload Format Indicator
16694 2: Message Expiry Interval
16695 3: Content Type
16696 8: Response Topic
16697 9: Correlation Data
16698 Not supported yet:
16699 38: User Property
16700
16701 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16702 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16703 packets only):
16704 17: Session Expiry Interval
16705 33: Receive Maximum
16706 36: Maximum QoS
16707 37: Retain Available
16708 39: Maximum Packet Size
16709 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16710 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16711 31: Reason String
16712 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16713 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16714 42: Shared Subscription Available
16715 19: Server Keep Alive
16716 26: Response Information
16717 28: Server Reference
16718 21: Authentication Method
16719 22: Authentication Data
16720 Not supported yet:
16721 38: User Property
16722
16723 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16724 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16725 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16726 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16727
16728 Example:
16729
16730 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16731 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16732 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16733 if data_in_buffer
16734 # do the same as above
16735 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16736 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16737 if data_in_buffer
16738
16739mqtt_is_valid
16740 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16741
16742 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16743 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16744 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16745 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16746
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016747 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16748
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016749 Example:
16750
16751 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016752 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016753
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016754mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016755 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016756 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16757 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016758 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016759 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016760 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016761 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16762 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16763 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16764 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016765 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016766 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016767
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016768nbsrv
16769 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16770 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16771 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16772 map lookup.
16773
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016774neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016775 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16776 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16777 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16778 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016779
16780not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016781 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016782 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016783 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016784 absence of a flag).
16785
16786odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016787 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016788 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16789
16790or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016791 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016792 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016793 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16794 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016795 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016796 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16797 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16798 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16799 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016800 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016801 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016802
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016803protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16804 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16805 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16806 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16807 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16808 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16809 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16810 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16811 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16812 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16813 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16814 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16815
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016816regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016817 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16818 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16819 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16820 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16821 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16822 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16823 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16824 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16825 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016826 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16827 of characters with other ones.
16828
16829 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16830 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16831 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16832 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16833 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16834 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016835
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016836 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016837
16838 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16839 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16840 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016841 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016842
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016843 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16844 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16845
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016846 # capture groups and backreferences
16847 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016848 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016849 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16850
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016851capture-req(<id>)
16852 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16853 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16854
16855 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016856 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16857 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016858
16859capture-res(<id>)
16860 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16861 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16862
16863 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016864 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16865 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016866
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016867rtrim(<chars>)
16868 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16869 of the input sample.
16870
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016871sdbm([<avalanche>])
16872 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16873 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16874 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16875 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16876 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16877 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16878 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016879 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16880 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016881
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016882secure_memcmp(<var>)
16883 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16884 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16885 match.
16886
16887 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16888 performed in constant time.
16889
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016890 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016891 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16892
16893 Example :
16894
16895 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16896 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16897 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16898 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16899
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016900set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016901 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16902 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16903 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016904 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016905 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16906 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016907 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016908 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16909 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016910 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016911 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016912
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016913sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016914 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016915 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16916
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016917sha2([<bits>])
16918 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16919 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16920
16921 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16922 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16923
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016924 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016925 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16926
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016927srv_queue
16928 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16929 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16930 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16931 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16932 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16933
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016934strcmp(<var>)
16935 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16936 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16937 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16938 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16939 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16940 shorter).
16941
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016942 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16943 strings in constant time.
16944
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016945 Example :
16946
16947 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16948 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16949 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16950
16951
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016952sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016953 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16954 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016955 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016956 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16957 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016958 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016959 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16960 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016961 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016962 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16963 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016964 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016965 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016966
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016967table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16968 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16969 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16970 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16971 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16972 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16973 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16974
16975
16976table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16979 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16980 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16981 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16982 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16983
16984table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16985 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16986 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016987 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016988 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16989 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16990
16991table_conn_cur(<table>)
16992 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16993 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16994 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16995 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16996 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16997
16998table_conn_rate(<table>)
16999 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17000 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17001 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17002 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17003 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17004
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017005table_gpt0(<table>)
17006 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17007 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17008 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17009 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17010 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17011
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017012table_gpc0(<table>)
17013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17016 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17017 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17018
17019table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17020 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17021 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17022 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17023 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17024 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17025 sample fetch keyword.
17026
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017027table_gpc1(<table>)
17028 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17029 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17030 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17031 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17032 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17033
17034table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17035 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17036 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17037 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17038 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17039 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17040 sample fetch keyword.
17041
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017042table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17043 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17044 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017045 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017046 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17047 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17048
17049table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17050 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17051 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17052 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17053 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17054 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17055 keyword.
17056
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017057table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17058 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17059 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17060 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17061 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17062 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17063
17064table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17065 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17066 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17067 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17068 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17069 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17070 keyword.
17071
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017072table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17073 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17074 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017075 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017076 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17077 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17078
17079table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17080 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17081 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17082 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17083 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17084 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17085 keyword.
17086
17087table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17088 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17089 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017090 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017091 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17092 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17093 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17094 keyword.
17095
17096table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17097 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17098 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017099 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017100 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17101 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17102 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17103 keyword.
17104
17105table_server_id(<table>)
17106 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17107 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17108 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17109 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17110 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17111 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17112
17113table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17114 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17115 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017116 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017117 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17118 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17119 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17120 keyword.
17121
17122table_sess_rate(<table>)
17123 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17124 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17125 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17126 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17127 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17128 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17129 keyword.
17130
17131table_trackers(<table>)
17132 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17133 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17134 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17135 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17136 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17137 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17138 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17139 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17140 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17141 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17142
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017143ub64dec
17144 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17145 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17146 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17147
17148 Example:
17149 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17150 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17151
17152ub64enc
17153 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17154
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017155upper
17156 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17157 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17158 type. The result is of type string.
17159
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017160url_dec([<in_form>])
17161 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17162 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17163 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17164 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17165 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17166 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017167
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017168url_enc([<enc_type>])
17169 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17170 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17171 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17172 optional argument is here for future changes.
17173
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017174ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017175 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017176 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17177 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17178 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017179 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17180 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17181 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17182 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017183 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017184 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17185 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017186
17187 Example:
17188 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17189 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17190
17191 message Point {
17192 int32 latitude = 1;
17193 int32 longitude = 2;
17194 }
17195
17196 message PPoint {
17197 Point point = 59;
17198 }
17199
17200 message Rectangle {
17201 // One corner of the rectangle.
17202 PPoint lo = 48;
17203 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17204 PPoint hi = 49;
17205 }
17206
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017207 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17208 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17209 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017210
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017211 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17212 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017213 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017214 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17215
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017216 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017217
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017218 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017219
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017220 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17221 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17222 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017223
17224 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17225 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17226 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17227
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017228 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17229 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17230 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017231
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017232
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017233unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017234 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17235 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17236 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17237 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17238 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17239 response),
17240 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17241 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17242 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17243 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17244
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017245utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17246 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17247 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17248 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17249 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17250 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17251 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17252
17253 Example :
17254
17255 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017256 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017257 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17258
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017259word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17260 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17261 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17262 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010017263 Empty words are skipped. This means that delimiters at the start or end of
17264 the input string are ignored and consecutive delimiters within the input
17265 string are considered to be a single delimiter.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017266 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17267 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17268
17269 Example :
17270 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010017271 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(5,_) # <not found>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017272 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17273 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17274 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17275 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017276 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010017277 str(/f1////f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017278
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017279wt6([<avalanche>])
17280 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17281 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17282 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17283 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17284 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17285 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17286 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017287 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17288 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017289
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017290xor(<value>)
17291 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017292 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017293 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017294 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017295 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017296 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17297 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017298 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017299 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17300 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017301 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017302 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017303
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017304xxh3([<seed>])
17305 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17306 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17307 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17308 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17309 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17310 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17311 considered as cryptographically secure.
17312
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017313xxh32([<seed>])
17314 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17315 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17316 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17317 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17318 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17319 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17320 as cryptographically secure.
17321
17322xxh64([<seed>])
17323 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17324 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17325 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17326 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17327 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17328 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17329 as cryptographically secure.
17330
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017331
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173327.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017333--------------------------------------------
17334
17335A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17336not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17337"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17338The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17339
17340always_false : boolean
17341 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17342 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17343
17344always_true : boolean
17345 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17346 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17347
17348avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017349 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017350 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17351 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17352 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17353 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17354 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17355 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17356 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17357 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17358 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17359 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17360 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17361 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17362 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017364be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017365 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17366 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17367 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17368 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017369 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17370
17371be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17372 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17373 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17374 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17375 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17376 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017377 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17378 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017379
17380 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17381 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17382 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017384be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17385 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17386 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17387 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017388 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017389 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17390 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017391
17392 Example :
17393 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17394 backend dynamic
17395 mode http
17396 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17397 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017398
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017399bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017400 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17401 of the string.
17402
17403bool(<bool>) : bool
17404 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17405 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017407connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17408 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017409 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017410 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17411 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017412
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017413 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017414 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017415 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17416
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017417 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17418 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017419
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017420 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017421 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017422 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017423 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017424 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017425 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017426 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017427
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017428 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17429 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017430 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017431 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017432
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017433cpu_calls : integer
17434 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17435 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17436 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17437 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17438 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17439 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17440
17441cpu_ns_avg : integer
17442 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17443 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17444 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17445 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17446 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17447 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17448 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17449 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17450 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17451 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17452 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17453
17454cpu_ns_tot : integer
17455 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17456 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17457 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17458 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17459 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17460 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17461 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17462 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17463 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17464 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17465 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17466 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17467 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17468
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017469date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017470 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017471
17472 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17473 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17474 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017475 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17476
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017477 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17478 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17479 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17480 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17481 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17482
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017483 Example :
17484
17485 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17486 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017487
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017488 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17489 # millisecond granularity
17490 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17491
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017492date_us : integer
17493 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17494 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17495 from the same timeval structure.
17496
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017497distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17498 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17499 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17500 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17501 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017502 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017503 list of supported tokens.
17504
17505distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17506 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17507 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17508 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17509 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017510 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017511 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17512 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17513 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17514 supported tokens.
17515
17516 Example :
17517 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17518 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17519 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17520 # send large files to the big farm
17521 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17522
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017523env(<name>) : string
17524 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17525 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17526 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17527 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17528 certain way.
17529
17530 Examples :
17531 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17532 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17533
17534 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017535 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017537fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17538 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017539 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17540 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017541 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17542 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017543 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017544 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17545 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017546
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017547fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17548 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17549 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17550 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017552fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17553 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17554 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17555 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17556 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17557 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17558 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17559 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17560 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017561
17562 Example :
17563 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17564 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17565 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17566 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17567 frontend mail
17568 bind :25
17569 mode tcp
17570 maxconn 100
17571 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17572 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17573 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17574 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017575
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017576hostname : string
17577 Returns the system hostname.
17578
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017579int(<integer>) : signed integer
17580 Returns a signed integer.
17581
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017582ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17583 Returns an ipv4.
17584
17585ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17586 Returns an ipv6.
17587
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017588lat_ns_avg : integer
17589 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17590 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17591 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17592 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17593 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17594 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17595 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17596 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17597 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017598 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17599 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17600 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17601 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17602 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17603 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017604
17605lat_ns_tot : integer
17606 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17607 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17608 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17609 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17610 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17611 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17612 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17613 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17614 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017615 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17616 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17617 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17618 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17619 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017620 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17621 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17622 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17623 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17624 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17625 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17626
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017627meth(<method>) : method
17628 Returns a method.
17629
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017630nbproc : integer
17631 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17632 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17633 and debugging purposes.
17634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017635nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17636 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17637 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17638 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017639 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17640 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17641 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017642
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017643prio_class : integer
17644 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17645 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17646 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17647
17648prio_offset : integer
17649 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17650 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17651 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17652 set-priority-offset".
17653
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017654proc : integer
17655 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17656 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17657 debugging purposes.
17658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017659queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017660 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17661 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17662 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017663 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17664 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17665 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17666 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17667 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17668
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017669rand([<range>]) : integer
17670 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17671 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17672 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17673 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17674 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017676srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17677 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17678 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17679 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17680 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17681 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017682 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17683 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17684
17685srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17686 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17687 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17688 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17689 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17690 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17691 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17692 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17693
17694 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17695 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017696
17697srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17698 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17699 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17700 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017701 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017702 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17703 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17704 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17705
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017706srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17707 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17708 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17709 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17710 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17711 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17712 fetch methods.
17713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017714srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17715 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17716 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017717 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017718 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17719 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017720 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017721 overloading servers).
17722
17723 Example :
17724 # Redirect to a separate back
17725 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17726 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17727 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17728
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017729srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017730 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17731 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17732 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17733
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017734srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017735 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17736 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17737 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17738
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017739srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017740 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17741 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17742 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17743
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017744stopping : boolean
17745 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17746 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17747 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17748
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017749str(<string>) : string
17750 Returns a string.
17751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017752table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17753 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17754 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17755
17756table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17757 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17758 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17759 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17760
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017761thread : integer
17762 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17763 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17764 and debugging purposes.
17765
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017766uuid([<version>]) : string
17767 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17768 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17769 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17770
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017771var(<var-name>) : undefined
17772 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017773 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17774 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017775 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017776 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17777 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017778 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017779 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17780 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017781 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017782 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017783
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177847.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017785----------------------------------
17786
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017787The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017788closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17789methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17790sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17791TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017792the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17793counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017794"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17795used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17796can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17797Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17798table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17799tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17800currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017801
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017802bc_dst : ip
17803 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17804 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17805 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17806 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17807
17808bc_dst_port : integer
17809 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017810 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017811
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017812bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017813 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17814 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17815 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17816
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017817bc_src : ip
17818 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017819 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017820 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17821 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17822
17823bc_src_port : integer
17824 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017825 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827be_id : integer
17828 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017829 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17830 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017831
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017832be_name : string
17833 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017834 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17835 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017836
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017837be_server_timeout : integer
17838 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17839 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17840 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17841
17842be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17843 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17844 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17845 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17846
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017847cur_server_timeout : integer
17848 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17849 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17850 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17851
17852cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17853 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17854 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17855 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017857dst : ip
17858 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17859 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17860 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17861 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017862 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17863 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17864 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17865 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17866 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17867 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017868
17869dst_conn : integer
17870 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17871 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17872 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17873 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17874 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17875 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17876 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17877 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017878
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017879dst_is_local : boolean
17880 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17881 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17882 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17883 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017884 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017885 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17886 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17887 it only once per connection.
17888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017889dst_port : integer
17890 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17891 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17892 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17893 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17894 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17895 an HTTP header.
17896
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017897fc_fackets : integer
17898 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17899 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17900 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17901 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17902
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017903fc_http_major : integer
17904 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17905 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17906 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17907
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017908fc_lost : integer
17909 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17910 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17911 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17912 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17913
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017914fc_pp_authority : string
17915 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17916 if any.
17917
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017918fc_pp_unique_id : string
17919 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17920 if any.
17921
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017922fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17923 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17924 header.
17925
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017926fc_reordering : integer
17927 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17928 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17929 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17930 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17931
17932fc_retrans : integer
17933 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17934 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17935 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17936 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17937
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017938fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17939 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17940 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17941 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17942 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17943 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17944 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17945
17946fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17947 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17948 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17949 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17950 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17951 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17952 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17953
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017954fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017955 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17956 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17957 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17958 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17959
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017960
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017961fc_unacked : integer
17962 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17963 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17964 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17965 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017966
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017967fe_defbe : string
17968 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17969 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017971fe_id : integer
17972 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017973 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017974 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17975
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017976fe_name : string
17977 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17978 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17979 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17980
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017981fe_client_timeout : integer
17982 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17983 current frontend.
17984
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017985sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017986sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17987sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17988sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017989 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17990 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17991 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17992
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017993sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017994sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17995sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17996sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017997 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17998 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17999 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18000
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018001sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018002sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18003sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18004sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018005 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18006 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018007 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18008 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18009 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018010
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018011 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018012 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18013 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018014 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18015 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18016 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018017 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18018 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18019
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018020sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18021sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18022sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18023sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18024 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18025 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18026 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18027 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18028 when a first ACL was verified.
18029
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018030sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018031sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18032sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18033sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018034 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018035 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18036
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018037sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018038sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18039sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18040sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018041 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18042 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18043 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18044
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018045sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018046sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18047sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18048sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018049 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18050 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18051 See also src_conn_rate.
18052
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018053sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018054sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18055sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18056sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018057 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018058 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018059
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018060sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18061sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18062sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18063sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18064 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18065 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18066
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018067sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18068sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18069sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18070sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18071 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18072 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018074sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018075sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18076sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18077sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018078 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18079 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18080 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018081 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18082 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18083 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018084
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018085sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18086sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18087sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18088sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18089 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18090 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18091 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18092 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18093 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18094 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18095
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018096sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018097sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18098sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18099sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018100 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018101 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18102 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018104sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018105sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18106sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18107sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018108 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18109 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18110 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18111 src_http_err_rate.
18112
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018113sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18114sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18115sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18116sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18117 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18118 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18119 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18120
18121sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18122sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18123sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18124sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18125 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18126 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18127 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18128 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18129
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018130sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018131sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18132sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18133sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018134 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018135 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18136 src_http_req_cnt.
18137
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018138sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018139sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18140sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18141sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018142 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18143 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18144 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18145 src_http_req_rate.
18146
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018147sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018148sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18149sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18150sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018151 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018152 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18153 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18154 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18155 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018156
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018157 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018158 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18159 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018160 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18161
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018162sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18163sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18164sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18165sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18166 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18167 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18168 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18169 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18170 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18171
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018172sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018173sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18174sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18175sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018176 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18177 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18178 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018179
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018180sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018181sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18182sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18183sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018184 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18185 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18186 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018187
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018188sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018189sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18190sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18191sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018192 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018193 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18194 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18195 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018196 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018197 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18198
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018199sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018200sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18201sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18202sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018203 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18204 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18205 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18206 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18207 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018208 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018209
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018210sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018211sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18212sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18213sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018214 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18215 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18216 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18217
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018218sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018219sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18220sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18221sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018222 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18223 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018224 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018225 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18226 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018227 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18228 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18229 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018231so_id : integer
18232 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18233 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18234 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018235
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018236so_name : string
18237 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18238 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18239 strings instead of integers.
18240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018241src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018242 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018243 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18244 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18245 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018246 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18247 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18248 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018249 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18250 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18251 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18252 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18253 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18254 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18255 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018256
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018257 Example:
18258 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18259 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018261src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18262 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18263 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18264 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018265 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018267src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18268 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18269 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018270 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018271 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18274 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18275 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18276 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18277 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18278 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18279 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018280
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018281 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018282 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18283 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18284 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18285 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018286 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018287 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18288 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18289
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018290src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18291 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18292 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18293 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18294 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18295 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18296 was verified.
18297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018298src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018299 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018300 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018301 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018302 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018304src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018305 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018306 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18307 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018308 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018310src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18311 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18312 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18313 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018314 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018316src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018317 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018318 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018319 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018320 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018321
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018322src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18323 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18324 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18325 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18326 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18327
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018328src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18329 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18330 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18331 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18332 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018334src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018335 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018337 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18338 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018339 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18340 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18341 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018342
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018343src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18344 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18345 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18346 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18347 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18348 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18349 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18350 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018352src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018353 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018354 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018355 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018356 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018357 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018359src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18360 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18361 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18362 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18363 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018364 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018365
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018366src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18367 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18368 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018369 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018370 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18371 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18372
18373src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18374 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18375 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18376 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18377 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18378 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18379 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018382 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018383 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18384 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018385 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018387src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18388 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18389 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18390 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018391 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018392 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018394src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18395 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18396 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18397 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018398 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018399 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18400 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018401
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018402 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018403 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018404 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018405 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018406
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018407src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18408 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18409 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18410 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18411 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18412 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18413 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18414
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018415src_is_local : boolean
18416 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18417 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18418 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18419 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018420 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018421 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18422 once per connection.
18423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018424src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018425 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18426 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18427 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18428 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18429 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018431src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018432 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18433 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18434 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18435 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18436 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018438src_port : integer
18439 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18440 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18441 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18442 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018444src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018445 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018446 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18447 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18448 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018449 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018451src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18452 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18453 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18454 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18455 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018456 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018458src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18459 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18460 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18461 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18462 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18463 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18464 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18465 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18466 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018467
18468 Example :
18469 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18470 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18471 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18472 listen ssh
18473 bind :22
18474 mode tcp
18475 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018476 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018477 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018478 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018480srv_id : integer
18481 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18482 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018483 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018484
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018485srv_name : string
18486 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18487 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018488 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018489
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018491----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018492
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018493The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018494closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18495when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18496usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018497future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018498
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001849951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18500 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18501 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18502 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18503 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18504 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18505
18506 Example :
18507 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18508 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18509 # the request.
18510 frontend http-in
18511 bind *:8081
18512 default_backend servers
18513 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18514 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18515
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018516ssl_bc : boolean
18517 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18518 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John3d379952023-05-22 13:11:13 -050018519 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018520 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018521
18522ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18523 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018524 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18525 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018526
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018527ssl_bc_alpn : string
18528 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18529 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018530 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018531 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18532 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18533 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18534 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18535 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018536 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18537 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018538
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018539ssl_bc_cipher : string
18540 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018541 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18542 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018543
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018544ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18545 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18546 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18547 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018548 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018549
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018550ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18551 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18552 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018553 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18554 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018555
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018556ssl_bc_npn : string
18557 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18558 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018559 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018560 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18561 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18562 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18563 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018564 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18565 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018566
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018567ssl_bc_protocol : string
18568 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018569 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18570 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018571
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018572ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018573 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018574 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018575 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18576 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018577
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018578ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18579 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18580 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18581 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018582 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018583
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018584ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18585 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18586 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018587 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18588 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018589
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018590ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18591 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18592 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18593 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018594 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018595
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018596ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18597 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018598 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18599 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018601ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18602 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18603 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18604 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18605 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18606 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018608ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18609 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18610 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18611 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18612 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018613
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018614ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018615 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18616 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18617 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018618 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018619 does not support resumed sessions.
18620
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018621ssl_c_der : binary
18622 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18623 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18624 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018626ssl_c_err : integer
18627 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18628 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18629 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18630 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18631 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018632
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018633ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018634 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18635 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18636 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18637 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18638 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18639 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18640 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18641 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018642 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18643 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18644 LDAP v3.
18645 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18646 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018648ssl_c_key_alg : string
18649 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18650 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18651 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018653ssl_c_notafter : string
18654 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18655 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18656 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018658ssl_c_notbefore : string
18659 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18660 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18661 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018662
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018663ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018664 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18665 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18666 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18667 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18668 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18669 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18670 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18671 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018672 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18673 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18674 LDAP v3.
18675 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18676 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018678ssl_c_serial : binary
18679 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18680 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18681 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018683ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18684 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18685 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18686 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018687 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18688 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18689
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018690 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018691 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18694 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18695 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18696 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018698ssl_c_used : boolean
18699 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18700 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702ssl_c_verify : integer
18703 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18704 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18705 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18706 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018708ssl_c_version : integer
18709 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18710 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018711
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018712ssl_f_der : binary
18713 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18714 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18715 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18716
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018717ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018718 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18719 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18720 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18721 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018722 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018723 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18724 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18725 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018726 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18727 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18728 LDAP v3.
18729 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18730 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018732ssl_f_key_alg : string
18733 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18734 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18735 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018737ssl_f_notafter : string
18738 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18739 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18740 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018742ssl_f_notbefore : string
18743 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18744 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18745 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018746
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018747ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018748 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18749 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18750 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18751 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18752 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18753 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18754 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18755 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018756 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18757 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18758 LDAP v3.
18759 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18760 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018762ssl_f_serial : binary
18763 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18764 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18765 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018766
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018767ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18768 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18769 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18770 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018772ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18773 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18774 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18775 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018777ssl_f_version : integer
18778 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18779 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18780
18781ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018782 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18783 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18784 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018786 Example :
18787 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18788 listen http-https
18789 bind :80
18790 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18791 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18792
18793ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18794 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18795 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18796
18797ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018798 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018799 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018800 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018801 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18802 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18803 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18804 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18805 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18806 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018808ssl_fc_cipher : string
18809 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18810 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018811
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018812ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18813 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18814 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018815 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018816
18817ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18818 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18819 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018820 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018821
18822ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18823 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18824 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18825 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018826 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018827 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018828
18829ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18830 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18831 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018832 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018833
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018834ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18835 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18836 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18837 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18838
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018839ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18840 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18841 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18842 transport layer.
18843 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18844 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18845 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18846 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18847
18848ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18849 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18850 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18851 transport layer.
18852 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18853 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18854 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18855 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18856
18857ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18858 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18859 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18860 transport layer.
18861 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18862 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18863 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18864 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18865
18866ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18867 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18868 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18869 transport layer.
18870 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18871 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18872 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18873 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18874
18875ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18876 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18877 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18878 transport layer.
18879 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18880 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18881 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18882 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018884ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018885 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18886 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018887 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18888 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18889 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18890 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018891
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018892ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18893 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18894 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18895 wait until the handshake happened.
18896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018897ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18898 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018899 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18900 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018901 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018902 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018903
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018904ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018905 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018906 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18907 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018909ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018910 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018911 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018912 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18913 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18914 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18915 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18916 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18917 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018919ssl_fc_protocol : string
18920 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18921 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018922
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018923ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018924 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018925 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018926 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018927
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018928ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18929 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18930 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18931 transport layer.
18932 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18933 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18934 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18935 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18936
18937ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18938 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18939 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18940 transport layer.
18941 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18942 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18943 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18944 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18945
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018946ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18947 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18948 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18949 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018951ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18952 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18953 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18954 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18955 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018956
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018957ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18958 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18959 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18960 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18961 BoringSSL.
18962
18963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018964ssl_fc_sni : string
18965 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18966 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018967 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018968 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18969 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18970
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018971 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018972 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018973 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018974 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018975 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018976
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010018977 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
18978 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
18979 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
18980 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
18981 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
18982 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
18983 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
18984 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
18985 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
18986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018987 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018988 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18989 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018991ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18992 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18993 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018994
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018995ssl_s_der : binary
18996 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18997 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18998 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18999
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019000ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19001 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19002 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19003 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019004 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019005 does not support resumed sessions.
19006
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019007ssl_s_key_alg : string
19008 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19009 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19010 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19011
19012ssl_s_notafter : string
19013 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19014 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19015 transport layer.
19016
19017ssl_s_notbefore : string
19018 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19019 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19020 transport layer.
19021
19022ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19023 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19024 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19025 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19026 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19027 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19028 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019029 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19030 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019031 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19032 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19033 LDAP v3.
19034 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19035 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19036
19037ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19038 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19039 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19040 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19041 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19042 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19043 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019044 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19045 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019046 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19047 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19048 LDAP v3.
19049 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19050 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19051
19052ssl_s_serial : binary
19053 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19054 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19055 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19056
19057ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19058 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19059 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19060 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19061
19062ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19063 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19064 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19065 layer.
19066
19067ssl_s_version : integer
19068 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19069 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019070
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190717.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019072------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019074Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19075sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19076only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19077For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19078be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19079can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19080sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19081for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19082content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019083
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019084Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19085 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019086 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019087 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19088 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19089 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19090 sample expression). So be careful.
19091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019092payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019093 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019094 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19095 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019097payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19098 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019099 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019100 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019102req.len : integer
19103req_len : integer (deprecated)
19104 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19105 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19106 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19107 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19108 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019109 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019110 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19111 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019113req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19114 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019115 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19116 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19117 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19118 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019119
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019120 ACL derivatives :
19121 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019123req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19124 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19125 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19126 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19127 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019128
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019129 ACL derivatives :
19130 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019132 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019134req.proto_http : boolean
19135req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19136 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19137 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19138 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19139 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19140 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19141 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19142 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019144 Example:
19145 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19146 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19147 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019148 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019150req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19151rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19152 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19153 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19154 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19155 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19156 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19157 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19158 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019160 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19161 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19162 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19163 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19164 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19165 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019167 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019168 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019170 Example :
19171 listen tse-farm
19172 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19173 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19174 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19175 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19176 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19177 persist rdp-cookie
19178 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19179 # This is only useful makes sense if
19180 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19181 stick-table type string size 204800
19182 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19183 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19184 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019186 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019187 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019189req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19190rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19191 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19192 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19193 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19194 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019196 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019197 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019198
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019199req.ssl_alpn : string
19200 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19201 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19202 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19203 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19204 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19205 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019206 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019207
19208 Examples :
19209 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19210 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019211 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019212 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019213 default_backend bk_default
19214
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019215req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19216 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19217 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019218 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19219 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19220 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19221 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19222 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019224req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19225req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19226 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19227 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19228 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19229 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19230 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19231 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19232 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019234req.ssl_sni : string
19235req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19236 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19237 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19238 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19239 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19240 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019241 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19242 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19243 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19244 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19245 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19246 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19247 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19248 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19249 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019251 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019252 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019254 Examples :
19255 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19256 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019257 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019258 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019259 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019260
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019261req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19262 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19263 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19264 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19265 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19266 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19267 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19268 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19269 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19270 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019272req.ssl_ver : integer
19273req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19274 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19275 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19276 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19277 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19278 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19279 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19280 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019281 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019282 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019284 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019285 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019286
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019287res.len : integer
19288 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19289 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19290 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19291 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19292 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019293 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019294 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019295 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019297res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19298 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019299 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019300 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019301 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019302 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019304res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19305 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19306 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19307 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019308 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19309 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019311 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019312
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019313res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19314rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19315 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19316 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19317 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19318 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19319 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19320 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19321 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019323wait_end : boolean
19324 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19325 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019326 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019327 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19328 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019329 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019330 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19331 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019333 Examples :
19334 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19335 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19336 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019338 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19339 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19340 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19341 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19342 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19343 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19344 tcp-request content reject
19345
19346
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193477.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019348--------------------------------------
19349
19350It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19351This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19352data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19353its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19354HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19355content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19356to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19357more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19358response are indexed.
19359
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019360Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19361 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19362 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19363 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19364 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19365 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19366 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019368base : string
19369 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19370 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19371 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19372 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19373 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19374 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19375 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19376 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19377
19378 ACL derivatives :
19379 base : exact string match
19380 base_beg : prefix match
19381 base_dir : subdir match
19382 base_dom : domain match
19383 base_end : suffix match
19384 base_len : length match
19385 base_reg : regex match
19386 base_sub : substring match
19387
19388base32 : integer
19389 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19390 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19391 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019392 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19393 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19394 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019395
19396base32+src : binary
19397 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19398 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19399 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19400 per-URL counters.
19401
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019402baseq : string
19403 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19404 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19405 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19406 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19407
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019408capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19409 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19410 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19411 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19412
19413capture.req.method : string
19414 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19415 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19416 because it's allocated.
19417
19418capture.req.uri : string
19419 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19420 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19421 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19422 allocated.
19423
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019424capture.req.ver : string
19425 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19426 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19427 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19428
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019429capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19430 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19431 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19432 The first entry is an index of 0.
19433 See also: "capture response header"
19434
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019435capture.res.ver : string
19436 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19437 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19438 persistent flag.
19439
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019440req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019441 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19442 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19443 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019444
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019445req.body_param([<name>) : string
19446 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19447 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19448 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19449 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19450 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19451 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19452 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19453 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19454 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19455 given.
19456
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019457req.body_len : integer
19458 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19459 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019460 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19461 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019462
19463req.body_size : integer
19464 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019465 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19466 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019468req.cook([<name>]) : string
19469cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19470 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19471 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19472 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19473 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19474 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19475 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19476 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19477 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19478
19479 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019480 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19481 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19482 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19483 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19484 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19485 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19486 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19487 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19490cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19491 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19492 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019494req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19495cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19496 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19497 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19498 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19499 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019501cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19502 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19503 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19504 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19505 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019506 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019507 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19508 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19509 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19510 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019512hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19513 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19514 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19515 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19516 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019517 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019519req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019520 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19521 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19522 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19523 with headers such as User-Agent.
19524
19525 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19526 found.
19527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019528 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19529 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19530 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019531 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019533req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19534 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19535 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019536 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19537 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019539req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019540 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19541 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19542 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19543 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19544 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19545 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19546 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19547
19548 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19549 found.
19550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019551 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19552 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19553 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019554 with -1 being the last one.
19555
19556 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19557 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559 ACL derivatives :
19560 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19561 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19562 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19563 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19564 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19565 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19566 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19567 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19568
19569req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19570hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19571 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19572 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019573 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19574 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19575 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19576
19577 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19578 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19579 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19580
19581 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019582
19583req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19584hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19585 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19586 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19587 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019588 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19589 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19590 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19591 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19592 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019593
19594 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19595
19596 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019597
19598req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19599hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19600 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19601 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19602 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019603
19604 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19605
19606 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019607
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019608req.hdrs : string
19609 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19610 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19611 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19612 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19613
19614req.hdrs_bin : binary
19615 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19616 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19617 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19618 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19619 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19620 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19621
19622 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019623
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019624 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19625 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019627http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19628 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19629 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19630 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19631 basic auth is supported.
19632
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019633http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19634 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19635 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19636 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19637 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019638 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19639 basic auth is supported.
19640
19641 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019642 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19643 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19644 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19645 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019646
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019647http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019648 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19649 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19650 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019651
19652http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019653 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19654 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19655 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019656
19657http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019658 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19659 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19660 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019662http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019663 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19664 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019665 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19666 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019668method : integer + string
19669 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19670 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19671 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19672 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19673 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19674 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19675 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019677 ACL derivatives :
19678 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019680 Example :
19681 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19682 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19683 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019685path : string
19686 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19687 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19688 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19689 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19690 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019691 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019692 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
19693 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
19694 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
19695 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
19696 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019698 ACL derivatives :
19699 path : exact string match
19700 path_beg : prefix match
19701 path_dir : subdir match
19702 path_dom : domain match
19703 path_end : suffix match
19704 path_len : length match
19705 path_reg : regex match
19706 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019707
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019708pathq : string
19709 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19710 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19711 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19712 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19713 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019714 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
19715 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
19716 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
19717 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
19718 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019719
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019720query : string
19721 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19722 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19723 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19724 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019725 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019726 which stops before the question mark.
19727
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019728req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19729 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19730 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19731 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19732 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019734req.ver : string
19735req_ver : string (deprecated)
19736 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19737 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19738 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019740 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019741 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019742
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019743res.body : binary
19744 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19745 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019746 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19747
19748 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019749
19750res.body_len : integer
19751 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19752 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019753 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19754
19755 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019756
19757res.body_size : integer
19758 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19759 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19760 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19761 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019762 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19763
19764 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019765
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019766res.cache_hit : boolean
19767 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19768 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19769
19770res.cache_name : string
19771 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19772 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19773 empty string.
19774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019775res.comp : boolean
19776 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19777 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19778 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019780res.comp_algo : string
19781 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19782 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19783 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019785res.cook([<name>]) : string
19786scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19787 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19788 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019789 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19790
19791 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019793 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019794 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019796res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19797scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19798 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19799 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019800 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19801
19802 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019804res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19805scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19806 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19807 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019808 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19809
19810 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019812res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019813 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19814 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19815
19816 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19817 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19818
19819 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19820
19821 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019823res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019824 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19825 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19826
19827 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19828 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19829
19830 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019832res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19833shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019834 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19835 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19836
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019837 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019838 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19839
19840 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019842 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019843 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19844 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19845 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19846 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19847 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19848 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19849 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19850 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019851
19852res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19853shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019854 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19855 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19856
19857 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019858 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019859
19860 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019862res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19863shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019864 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19865 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19866
19867 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19868
19869 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019870
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019871res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19872 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19873 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19874 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019875 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19876
19877 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019879res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19880shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019881 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19882 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19883
19884 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19885
19886 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019887
19888res.hdrs : string
19889 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19890 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19891 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019892 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19893
19894 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019895
19896res.hdrs_bin : binary
19897 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19898 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19899 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19900 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19901 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19902 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19903 (length of 0 for both).
19904
19905 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19906
19907 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19908 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019910res.ver : string
19911resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19912 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019913 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19914
19915 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019917 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019918 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019920set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19921 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19922 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019923 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019924 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019926 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19927 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019929status : integer
19930 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19931 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019932 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19933
19934 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019935
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019936unique-id : string
19937 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19938 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19939 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19940 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19941 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19942 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019944url : string
19945 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19946 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19947 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19948 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19949 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19950 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019951 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
19952 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
19953 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
19954 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
19955 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019957 ACL derivatives :
19958 url : exact string match
19959 url_beg : prefix match
19960 url_dir : subdir match
19961 url_dom : domain match
19962 url_end : suffix match
19963 url_len : length match
19964 url_reg : regex match
19965 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019967url_ip : ip
19968 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19969 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19970 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19971 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19972 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19973 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19974 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019976url_port : integer
19977 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19978 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19979 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19980 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019981
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019982urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19983url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019984 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19985 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019986 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19987 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19988 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19989 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019990 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19991 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019992 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19993 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019995 ACL derivatives :
19996 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19997 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19998 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19999 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20000 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20001 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20002 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20003 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020004
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020006 Example :
20007 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20008 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20009 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20010 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020011
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020012urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020013 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20014 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20015 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020016
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020017url32 : integer
20018 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20019 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20020 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20021 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20022 is an unsigned integer.
20023
20024url32+src : binary
20025 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20026 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20027 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20028
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020029
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200200307.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020031---------------------------------------
20032
20033This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20034used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20035purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20036There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20037or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20038any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20039for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20040
20041internal.htx.data : integer
20042 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20043 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20044
20045internal.htx.free : integer
20046 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20047 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20048
20049internal.htx.free_data : integer
20050 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20051 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20052
20053internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020054 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20055 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20056 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020057
20058internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20059 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20060 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20061
20062internal.htx.size : integer
20063 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20064 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20065
20066internal.htx.used : integer
20067 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20068 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20069 direction.
20070
20071internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20072 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20073 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20074 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20075 of the special value :
20076 * head : The oldest inserted block
20077 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020078 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020079
20080internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20081 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20082 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20083 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20084 integer or one of the special value :
20085 * head : The oldest inserted block
20086 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020087 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020088
20089internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20090 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20091 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20092 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20093 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20094
20095 * head : The oldest inserted block
20096 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020097 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020098
20099internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20100 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20101 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20102 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20103 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20104
20105 * head : The oldest inserted block
20106 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020107 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020108
20109internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20110 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20111 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20112 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20113 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20114
20115 * head : The oldest inserted block
20116 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020117 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020118
20119internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20120 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20121 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20122 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20123 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20124
20125 * head : The oldest inserted block
20126 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020127 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020128
20129internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20130 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20131 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20132 it returns false.
20133
20134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200201357.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020136---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020138Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20139every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020140order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020142ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020143---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20144FALSE always_false never match
20145HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20146HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20147HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020148HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020149HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20150HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20151HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20152HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20153LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20154METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20155METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20156METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20157METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20158METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20159METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20160METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20161METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20162RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20163REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20164TRUE always_true always match
20165WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20166---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020167
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201698. Logging
20170----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020171
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020172One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20173provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20174very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20175provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20176state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020177to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020178headers.
20179
20180In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20181about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20182send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20183
20184 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20185 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20186 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20187 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20188 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020189 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020190 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020191
20192The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20193allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20194as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20195while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20196real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20197delay.
20198
20199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202008.1. Log levels
20201---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020202
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020203TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020204source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020205HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20206in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20207track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20208syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20209about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020210
20211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202128.2. Log formats
20213----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020214
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020215HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020216and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20217slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20218options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020219
20220 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20221 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20222 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20223 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20224 extents.
20225
20226 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20227 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20228 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20229 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20230 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20231
20232 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20233 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20234 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20235 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20236 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20237
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020238 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20239 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20240 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20241 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20242
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020243 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20244
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020245Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20246specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20247field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20248servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20249always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20250identifier.
20251
20252Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20253 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20254 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20255 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20256 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20257
20258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202598.2.1. Default log format
20260-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020261
20262This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20263as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20264format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20265
20266 Example :
20267 listen www
20268 mode http
20269 log global
20270 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20271
20272 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20273 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20274 (www/HTTP)
20275
20276 Field Format Extract from the example above
20277 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20278 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20279 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20280 4 'to' to
20281 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20282 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20283
20284Detailed fields description :
20285 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20286 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20287 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20288 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20289 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20290 and processed the connection.
20291 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20292
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020293In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20294"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20295connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20296
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020297It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20298will eventually disappear.
20299
20300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203018.2.2. TCP log format
20302---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020303
20304The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20305is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20306information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20307counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20308emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20309environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20310the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20311sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020312specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20313not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20314fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20315marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020316
20317 Example :
20318 frontend fnt
20319 mode tcp
20320 option tcplog
20321 log global
20322 default_backend bck
20323
20324 backend bck
20325 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20326
20327 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20328 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20329 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20330
20331 Field Format Extract from the example above
20332 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20333 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20334 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20335 4 frontend_name fnt
20336 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20337 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20338 7 bytes_read* 212
20339 8 termination_state --
20340 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20341 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20342
20343Detailed fields description :
20344 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020345 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020346 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20347 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020348 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020349 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020350 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020351
20352 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020353 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20354 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20355 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020356
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020357 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020358 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20359 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020360 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20361 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20362 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20363 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020364
20365 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20366 and processed the connection.
20367
20368 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20369 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20370 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20371 applications.
20372
20373 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20374 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20375 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20376 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20377 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20378
20379 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20380 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20381 See "Timers" below for more details.
20382
20383 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20384 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20385 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20386 "Timers" below for more details.
20387
20388 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020389 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020390 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20391 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20392 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20393 details.
20394
20395 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20396 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20397 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20398 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20399 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20400
20401 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20402 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20403 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20404 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20405 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20406 for more details.
20407
20408 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020409 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020410 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20411 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20412 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020413 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020414
20415 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20416 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20417 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20418 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20419 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20420 caused by a denial of service attack.
20421
20422 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20423 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20424 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20425 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20426 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20427 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20428 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20429 denial of service attack.
20430
20431 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20432 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20433 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20434 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20435 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20436 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20437 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20438 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20439 be processed than on other servers.
20440
20441 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20442 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20443 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20444 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020445 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020446 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20447 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20448 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20449 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20450 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20451 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20452 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20453 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20454
20455 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20456 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20457 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20458 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20459 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20460 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020461 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020462 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20463
20464 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20465 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20466 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20467 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20468 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20469 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020470 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020471 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20472 occurs.
20473
20474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204758.2.3. HTTP log format
20476----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020477
20478The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20479is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20480the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20481are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20482emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20483generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20484"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20485which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020486frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20487is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020488
20489Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20490slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20491with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20492
20493 Example :
20494 frontend http-in
20495 mode http
20496 option httplog
20497 log global
20498 default_backend bck
20499
20500 backend static
20501 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20502
20503 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20504 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20505 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020506 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020507
20508 Field Format Extract from the example above
20509 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20510 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020511 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020512 4 frontend_name http-in
20513 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020514 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020515 7 status_code 200
20516 8 bytes_read* 2750
20517 9 captured_request_cookie -
20518 10 captured_response_cookie -
20519 11 termination_state ----
20520 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20521 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20522 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20523 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20524 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020525
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020526Detailed fields description :
20527 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020528 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020529 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20530 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020531 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020532 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020533 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020534
20535 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020536 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20537 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20538 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020539
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020540 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020541 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020542
20543 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20544 and processed the connection.
20545
20546 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20547 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20548 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20549
20550 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20551 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20552 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20553 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20554 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20555 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20556
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020557 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20558 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20559 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020560 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020561 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20562 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020563 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020564 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020565
20566 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20567 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020568 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020569
20570 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20571 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020572 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20573 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020574
20575 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20576 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20577 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20578 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20579 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020580 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20581 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020582
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020583 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020584 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20585 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20586 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20587 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20588 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20589 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020590 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020591
20592 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020593 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20594 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020595
20596 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20597 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020598 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020599 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20600 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20601 overflowing.
20602
20603 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20604 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20605 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20606 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20607 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20608 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20609 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20610 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20611
20612 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20613 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20614 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20615 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20616 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20617 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20618 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20619 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20620
20621 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20622 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20623 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20624 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20625 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20626 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20627 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20628
20629 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020630 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020631 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20632 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20633 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020634 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020635 system.
20636
20637 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20638 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20639 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20640 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20641 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20642 caused by a denial of service attack.
20643
20644 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20645 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20646 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20647 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20648 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20649 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20650 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20651 denial of service attack.
20652
20653 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20654 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20655 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20656 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20657 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20658 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20659 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20660 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20661 processed than on other servers.
20662
20663 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20664 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20665 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20666 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020667 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020668 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20669 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20670 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20671 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20672 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20673 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20674 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20675 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20676
20677 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20678 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20679 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20680 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20681 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20682 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020683 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020684 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20685
20686 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20687 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20688 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20689 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20690 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20691 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020692 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020693 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20694 occurs.
20695
20696 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20697 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20698 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20699 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20700 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20701 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20702 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20703 cookies" below for more details.
20704
20705 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20706 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20707 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20708 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20709 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20710 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20711 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20712 and cookies" below for more details.
20713
20714 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20715 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20716 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20717 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20718 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20719 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20720 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20721 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20722
20723
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200207248.2.4. Custom log format
20725------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020726
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020727The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020728mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020729
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020730HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020731Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20732separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20733prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20734
20735Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20736variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020737("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020738
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020739If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020740as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020741less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20742the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20743
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020744Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20745"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20746delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20747preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020748
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020749Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20750'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20751https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20752such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20753
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020754Flags are :
20755 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020756 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020757 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20758 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020759
20760 Example:
20761
20762 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20763 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20764
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020765 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20766
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020767At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20768
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020769 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20770 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020771
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020772the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020773
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020774 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20775 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20776 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020777
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020778and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20779
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020780 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20781 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020782
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020783Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20784
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020785 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020786 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020787 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20788 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20789 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020790 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20791 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20792 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020793 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020794 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020795 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020796 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020797 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020798 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20799 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020800 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020801 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020802 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020803 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020804 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020805 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020806 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020807 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20808 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20809 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20810 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20811 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020812 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020813 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020814 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020815 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020816 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020817 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20818 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020819 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20820 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20821 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020822 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020823 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20824 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020825 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020826 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20827 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20828 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020829 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020830 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020831 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20832 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20833 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20834 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020835 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020836 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020837 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020838 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020839 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020840 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020841 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20842 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20843 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020844 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020845 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20846 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020847 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020848 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20849 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020850 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020851 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020852 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020853 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020854
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020855 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020856
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020857
208588.2.5. Error log format
20859-----------------------
20860
20861When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020862protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020863By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20864"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020865will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020866logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20867
20868The format looks like this :
20869
20870 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20871 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20872 Connection error during SSL handshake
20873
20874 Field Format Extract from the example above
20875 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20876 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20877 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20878 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20879 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20880
20881These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20882failures.
20883
20884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208858.3. Advanced logging options
20886-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020887
20888Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20889just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20890options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20891for more information about their usage.
20892
20893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20895------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020896
20897It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020898HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020899commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20900monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20901ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20902
20903 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20904 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20905 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20906 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20907
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020908 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20909 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020910
20911 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20912 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20913 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20914
20915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209168.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20917----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020918
20919The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20920what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20921or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020922"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020923just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20924log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20925after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20926is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20927with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20928with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20929
20930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209318.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20932------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020933
20934Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20935for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20936"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20937retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20938raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20939a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20940file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20941you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20942"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20943
20944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209458.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20946--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020947
20948Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20949multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20950them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20951"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20952logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20953error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20954and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20955too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20956useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20957alternative.
20958
20959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209608.4. Timing events
20961------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020962
20963Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20964reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20965the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20966frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020967mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20968addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20969
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020970Timings events in HTTP mode:
20971
20972 first request 2nd request
20973 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20974 t tr t tr ...
20975 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20976 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20977 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20978 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020979 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020980 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20981
20982Timings events in TCP mode:
20983
20984 TCP session
20985 |<----------------->|
20986 t t
20987 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20988 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20989 |<------ Tt ------->|
20990
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020991 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020992 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020993 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20994 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20995 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020996 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020997 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20998 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20999 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21000 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021001
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021002 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21003 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21004 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021005 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21006 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21007 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21008 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21009 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21010 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021011
21012 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21013 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21014 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21015 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21016 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21017 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21018 request typed by hand during a test.
21019
21020 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21021 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021022 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021023 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21024 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21025 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21026 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021027
21028 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21029 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21030 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21031 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21032 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21033
21034 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21035 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21036 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21037 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21038 connection never established.
21039
21040 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21041 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21042 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21043 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21044 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21045 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21046 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21047 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21048 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21049 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21050 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21051
William Lallemand90b82122023-07-25 09:06:51 +020021052 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
21053 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
21054 (after Tr).
21055
21056 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
21057 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
21058
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021059 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21060 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21061 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21062 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21063 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21064 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21065
21066 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21067
21068 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21069 "Ta" can never be negative.
21070
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021071 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21072 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021073 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21074 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021075 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021076
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021077 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021078
21079 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021080 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21081 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021082
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021083 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21084 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21085 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21086 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21087 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21088 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21089 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21090 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21091
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021092These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21093protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21094that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021095due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21096"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21097that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021098
21099Most common cases :
21100
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021101 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21102 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21103 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21104 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21105 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021106 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021107 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21108 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21109 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21110 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21111 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021112 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021113
21114 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21115 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21116 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21117 of ms on remote networks.
21118
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021119 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21120 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21121 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021122
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021123 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21124 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021125 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021126 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21127 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21128 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21129 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21130 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21131 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021132
21133Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21134
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021135 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021136 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021137 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021138
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021139 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021140 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21141 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21142
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021143 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021144 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21145 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21146 flags.
21147
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021148 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21149 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021150 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21151 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21152 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21153 the client connection was maintained open.
21154
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021155 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021156 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021157 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021158 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21159
21160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211618.5. Session state at disconnection
21162-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021163
21164TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21165"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
211662-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21167each of which has a special meaning :
21168
21169 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21170 session to terminate :
21171
21172 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21173
21174 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21175 server explicitly refused it.
21176
21177 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21178 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21179 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21180 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021181 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021182
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021183 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021184 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021185
21186 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21187 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21188 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21189 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21190 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21191
21192 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21193 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21194 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21195 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21196 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21197
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021198 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021199 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21200
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021201 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021202 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21203 backup connections when going up.
21204
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021205 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021206
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021207 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21208 send or receive data.
21209
21210 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21211 send or receive data.
21212
21213 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21214 with nothing left in the buffers.
21215
21216 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21217
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021218 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021219 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21220
21221 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21222 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21223 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21224 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21225 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21226
21227 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21228 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21229
21230 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21231 server (HTTP only).
21232
21233 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21234
21235 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21236 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21237 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21238
21239 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21240 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21241 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21242
21243 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21244
21245 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21246 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21247
21248 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21249 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21250 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21251
21252 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21253 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021254 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21255 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021256
21257 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21258 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21259 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21260 another server.
21261
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021262 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021263 server.
21264
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021265 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21266 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21267 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21268 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21269
21270 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21271 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21272 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21273 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21274
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021275 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21276 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21277 "use-server" rule).
21278
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021279 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21280
21281 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21282 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21283
21284 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21285
21286 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21287 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21288 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21289
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021290 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21291 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021292 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021293 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21294 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21295
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021296 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21297
21298 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21299 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21300
21301 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21302
21303 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21304
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021305The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21306was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021307helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21308starvation, attacks, etc...
21309
21310The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21311alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21312easier finding and understanding.
21313
21314 Flags Reason
21315
21316 -- Normal termination.
21317
21318 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021319 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21320 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021321 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21322
21323 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21324 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021325 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21326 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021327 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21328 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021329
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021330 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21331 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021332 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021333
21334 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21335 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21336 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21337
21338 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21339 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21340 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21341 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21342 the server takes too long to respond.
21343
21344 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21345 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21346 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21347 long a time to respond.
21348
21349 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21350 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21351 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021352 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021353 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21354 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021355
21356 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21357 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21358 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21359 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21360 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021361 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021362 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21363 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21364 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21365 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21366 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21367 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21368 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21369 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021370 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021371 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21372 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21373 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021374
21375 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21376 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021377 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21378 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21379 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21380 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021381
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021382 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021383 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21384
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021385 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021386 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21387 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021388 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021389 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21390 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21391
21392 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21393 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21394 503 or 504 here.
21395
21396 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021397 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021398 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21399 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21400 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21401
21402 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21403 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021404 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021405 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021406 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021407
21408 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21409 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21410 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21411 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21412 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21413 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021414 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021415
21416 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21417 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21418 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21419 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21420 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21421 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21422 solution is to fix the application.
21423
21424 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21425 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21426 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21427 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21428 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21429 external attacks.
21430
21431 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021432 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021433 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021434 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21435 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21436
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021437 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21438 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21439 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021440 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021441 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021442
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021443 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21444 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21445 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21446 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021447 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21448 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21449 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21450 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021451 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21452 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21453 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21454 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021455
21456 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21457 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21458 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021459 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21460 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21461 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21462 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021463
21464 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21465 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21466 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21467 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21468
21469 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21470 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21471 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21472 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21473
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021474The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021475persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021476important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21477re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21478
21479 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21480
21481 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21482 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21483 set on a GET request.
21484
21485 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21486 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021487 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021488 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21489
21490 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21491 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21492 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21493
21494 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21495 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21496 already got a cookie.
21497
21498 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21499 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21500 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21501 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21502 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21503
21504 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21505 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21506 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21507
21508 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21509 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21510 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21511
21512 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21513 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21514
21515 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21516 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21517 then advertised in the response.
21518
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215208.6. Non-printable characters
21521-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021522
21523In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21524consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21525converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21526prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21527being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21528escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21529is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21530'}' when logging headers.
21531
21532Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21533issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21534containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21535
21536Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21537the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21538performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21539
21540
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215418.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21542---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021543
21544Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21545achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021546section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021547cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21548the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21549the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021550locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021551not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21552user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21553a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21554wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21555
21556 Examples :
21557 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21558 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21559
21560 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21561 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21562
21563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215648.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21565---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021566
21567Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21568proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21569the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21570server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21571
21572Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21573response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021574section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021575
21576It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021577time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21578appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021579are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21580and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21581follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21582request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21583in the logs.
21584
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021585As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21586frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21587an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21588
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021589 Example :
21590 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21591 listen proxy-out
21592 mode http
21593 option httplog
21594 option logasap
21595 log global
21596 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21597
21598 # log the name of the virtual server
21599 capture request header Host len 20
21600
21601 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21602 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21603
21604 # log the beginning of the referrer
21605 capture request header Referer len 20
21606
21607 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21608 capture response header Server len 20
21609
21610 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21611 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21612
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021613 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021614 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21615
21616 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21617 capture response header Via len 20
21618
21619 # log the URL location during a redirection
21620 capture response header Location len 20
21621
21622 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21623 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21624 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21625 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21626 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21627
21628 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21629 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21630 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21631 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021632 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021633
21634 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21635 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21636 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21637 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21638 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021639 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021640
21641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216428.9. Examples of logs
21643---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021644
21645These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21646them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21647reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21648
21649 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21650 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21651 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21652
21653 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21654 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21655
21656 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21657 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21658 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21659
21660 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21661 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21662
21663 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21664 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21665 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21666
21667 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021668 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021669 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21670 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21671
21672 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21673 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21674 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21675
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021676 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21677 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21678 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21679 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021680 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021681 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021682
21683 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021684 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021685
21686 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21687 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21688 Nothing was sent to any server.
21689
21690 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21691 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21692
21693 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21694 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021695 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021696 send a 408 return code to the client.
21697
21698 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21699 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21700
21701 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21702 5 seconds ("c----").
21703
21704 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21705 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021706 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021707
21708 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021709 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021710 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21711 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21712 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21713 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21714 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021715
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021716
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200217179. Supported filters
21718--------------------
21719
21720Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21721accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21722unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21723
21724See also : "filter"
21725
217269.1. Trace
21727----------
21728
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021729filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021730
21731 Arguments:
21732 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21733 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21734
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021735 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021736
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021737 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021738 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21739 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21740 amount of the parsed data.
21741
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021742 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021743
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021744This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21745callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21746information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21747filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21748
21749Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21750tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21751a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21752
21753
217549.2. HTTP compression
21755---------------------
21756
21757filter compression
21758
21759The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21760keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021761when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21762fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21763done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21764explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21765filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21766listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21767order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021768
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021769See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21770 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021771
21772
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200217739.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21774--------------------------------------------
21775
21776filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21777
21778 Arguments :
21779
21780 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21781 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21782 parsed.
21783
21784 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21785 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21786 part must be placed in its own scope.
21787
21788The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21789external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021790streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021791exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21792also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21793
21794SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21795the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21796
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021797For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021798"doc/SPOE.txt".
21799
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100218009.4. Cache
21801----------
21802
21803filter cache <name>
21804
21805 Arguments :
21806
21807 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21808
21809The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21810"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021811cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021812other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21813case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21814is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21815filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021816listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21817order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021818
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021819See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21820 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21821
21822
218239.5. Fcgi-app
21824-------------
21825
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021826filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021827
21828 Arguments :
21829
21830 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21831
21832The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21833request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21834reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21835used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21836implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21837used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21838fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21839used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21840order.
21841
21842See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21843 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21844
21845
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100218469.6. OpenTracing
21847----------------
21848
21849The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21850HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21851of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21852Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21853
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021854This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021855
21856The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21857HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21858participates in the work of HAProxy.
21859
21860filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21861
21862 Arguments :
21863
21864 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21865 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21866 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21867 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21868 OpenTracing filters.
21869
21870 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21871 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21872 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21873 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21874 filter must have its own scope defined.
21875
21876More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021877of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021878
21879
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002188010. FastCGI applications
21881-------------------------
21882
21883HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21884feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21885the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21886FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21887servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21888FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21889backend.
21890
21891HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21892application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21893connection.
21894
2189510.1. Setup
21896-----------
21897
2189810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21899--------------------------
21900
21901fcgi-app <name>
21902 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21903 document root must be defined.
21904
21905acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21906 Declare or complete an access list.
21907
21908 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21909 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21910 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21911 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21912 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21913
21914docroot <path>
21915 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21916 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21917 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21918
21919index <script-name>
21920 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21921 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21922 is an optional setting.
21923
21924 Example :
21925 index index.php
21926
21927log-stderr global
21928log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021929 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021930 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21931
21932 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21933 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21934
21935pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21936 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21937 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21938 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21939
21940 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21941 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21942 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21943 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21944
21945 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21946 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21947
21948path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021949 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021950 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21951 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21952 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21953 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21954 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21955 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21956 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021957
21958 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021959 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021960 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21961 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21962 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21963 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021964
21965 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021966 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21967 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021968
21969option get-values
21970no option get-values
21971 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21972
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021973 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021974 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21975
21976 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21977 application will accept.
21978
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021979 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21980 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021981
21982 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021983 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021984 option is disabled.
21985
21986 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21987 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21988 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21989 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21990 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21991 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21992
21993option keep-conn
21994no option keep-conn
21995 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21996 sending a response.
21997
21998 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21999 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22000
22001option max-reqs <reqs>
22002 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22003 accept.
22004
22005 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22006 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22007 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22008 to 1.
22009
22010option mpxs-conns
22011no option mpxs-conns
22012 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22013
22014 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22015 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22016
22017set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22018 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22019 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22020 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22021 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22022
22023 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22024 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22025 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22026
22027 Example :
22028 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22029 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22030
22031 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22032
22033
2203410.1.2. Proxy section
22035---------------------
22036
22037use-fcgi-app <name>
22038 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22039
22040 Arguments :
22041 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22042
22043 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22044 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22045 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22046 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22047 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22048
22049 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22050 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22051 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22052 application are evaluated.
22053
22054
2205510.1.3. Example
22056---------------
22057
22058 frontend front-http
22059 mode http
22060 bind *:80
22061 bind *:
22062
22063 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22064 default_backend back-static
22065
22066 backend back-static
22067 mode http
22068 server www A.B.C.D:80
22069
22070 backend back-dynamic
22071 mode http
22072 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22073 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22074
22075 fcgi-app php-fpm
22076 log-stderr global
22077 option keep-conn
22078
22079 docroot /var/www/my-app
22080 index index.php
22081 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22082
22083
2208410.2. Default parameters
22085------------------------
22086
22087A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22088the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022089script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022090applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22091
22092 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22093 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22094 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22095 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22096 | | |
22097 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22098 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22099 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22100 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22101 | | application. |
22102 | | |
22103 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22104 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22105 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22106 | | |
22107 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22108 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22109 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22110 | | the application's configuration. |
22111 | | |
22112 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22113 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22114 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22115 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22116 | | |
22117 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22118 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22119 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22120 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22121 | | be defined. |
22122 | | |
22123 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22124 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22125 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22126 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22127 | | is not set too. |
22128 | | |
22129 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22130 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22131 | | set. |
22132 | | |
22133 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22134 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22135 | | the request. |
22136 | | |
22137 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22138 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22139 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22140 | | |
22141 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22142 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22143 | | script to process the request. |
22144 | | |
22145 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22146 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22147 | | |
22148 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22149 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22150 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22151 | | |
22152 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22153 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22154 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22155 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22156 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22157 | | |
22158 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22159 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22160 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22161 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22162 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22163 | | side. |
22164 | | |
22165 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22166 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22167 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22168 | | connected to. |
22169 | | |
22170 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22171 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22172 | | |
22173 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022174 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22175 | | current HAProxy version. |
22176 | | |
22177 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022178 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22179 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22180 | | |
22181 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22182
22183
2218410.3. Limitations
22185------------------
22186
22187The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22188way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22189during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22190establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22191application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22192or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22193message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22194these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22195and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22196
22197Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22198request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22199requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22200
22201About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22202into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22203fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22204"http-request" ones.
22205
22206Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22207FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22208processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22209must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22210here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022211
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022212
2221311. Address formats
22214-------------------
22215
22216Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22217address.
22218
22219This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22220The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22221of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22222equivalent is '::'.
22223
22224Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22225is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22226
22227This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22228family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22229
22230Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22231configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22232use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22233'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22234
22235Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22236socket type and the transport method.
22237
22238
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002223911.1. Address family prefixes
22240-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022241
22242'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22243
22244'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22245 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22246 listening.
22247
22248'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22249 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22250 on the statement using this address, a port or
22251 a port range may or must be specified.
22252
22253'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22254 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22255 using this address, a port or a port range
22256 may or must be specified.
22257
22258'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22259 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22260 using this address, a port or a port range
22261 may or must be specified.
22262
22263'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22264 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22265 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22266 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22267 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22268 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22269
22270'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22271 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22272 start by slash '/'.
22273
22274
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002227511.2. Socket type prefixes
22276--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022277
22278Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22279type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22280this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22281This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22282but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22283
22284Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
Willy Tarreaudc2b3f82023-01-16 12:07:12 +010022285instead use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes".
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022286
22287If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22288they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22289report this to the maintainers.
22290
22291'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22292 to "stream"
22293
22294'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22295 to "datagram".
22296
22297
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002229811.3. Protocol prefixes
22299-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022300
22301'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22302 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22303 socket type and transport method is forced to
22304 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22305 this address, a port or a port range can or
22306 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22307 of 'stream+ip@'.
22308
22309'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22310 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22311 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22312 statement using this address, a port or port
22313 range can or must be specified.
22314 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22315
22316'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22317 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22318 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22319 statement using this address, a port or port
22320 range can or must be specified.
22321 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22322
22323'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22324 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22325 socket type and transport method is forced to
22326 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22327 this address, a port or a port range can or
22328 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22329 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22330
22331'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22332 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22333 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22334 the statement using this address, a port or
22335 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022336 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022337
22338'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22339 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22340 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22341 the statement using this address, a port or
22342 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022343 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022344
22345'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22346 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22347 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22348
22349'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22350 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22351 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22352
22353In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22354QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022356/*
22357 * Local variables:
22358 * fill-column: 79
22359 * End:
22360 */